blob: c565389a99ed3d787bf0b07e891f1dbd2e708b2e [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaua3393952014-05-10 15:16:43 +02007 2014/05/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100500 - tune.zlib.memlevel
501 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100502
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200503 * Debugging
504 - debug
505 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506
507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005083.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200509------------------------------------
510
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200511ca-base <dir>
512 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200513 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
514 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200515
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516chroot <jail dir>
517 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
518 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
519 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
520 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
521 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
522 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100523
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100524cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
525 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
526 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
527 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100528 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
529 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
530 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
531 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
532 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
533 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
534 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
535 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
536 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
537 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100538
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200539crt-base <dir>
540 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
541 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
542 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
543
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544daemon
545 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
546 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
547 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
548
549gid <number>
550 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
551 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
552 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100553 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
554 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200555 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100556
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557group <group name>
558 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
559 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100560
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200561log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
563 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100564 configured with "log global".
565
566 <address> can be one of:
567
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100568 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100569 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
570 port).
571
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100572 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
573 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
574 port).
575
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
577 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
578 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
579 writeable).
580
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100581 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
582 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
583 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
584 in Bourne shell.
585
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100586 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587
588 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
589 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
590 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
591
592 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200593 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
594 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
595 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
596 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
597 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
598 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200599
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200600 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100602log-send-hostname [<string>]
603 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
604 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
605 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
606 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
607 the logs.
608
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000609log-tag <string>
610 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
611 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
612 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
613 running on the same host.
614
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615nbproc <number>
616 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
617 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
618 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
619 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
620 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
621
622pidfile <pidfile>
623 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
624 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
625 starting the process. See also "daemon".
626
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100627stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200628 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
629 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
630 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
631 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
632 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
633 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100634 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200635 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
636 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200637
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100638ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
639 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
640 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300641 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100642 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
643 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
644 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
645 "bind" keyword for more information.
646
647ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
648 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
649 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300650 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100651 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
652 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
653 information.
654
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100655ssl-server-verify [none|required]
656 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
657 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
658 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
659
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200660stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
661 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
662 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
663 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
664 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200665
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200666 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
667 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
668 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200669
670stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
671 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
672 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100673 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200674
675stats maxconn <connections>
676 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
677 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
678
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200679uid <number>
680 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
681 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
682 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
683 one. See also "gid" and "user".
684
685ulimit-n <number>
686 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
687 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
688 option.
689
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100690unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
691 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
692
693 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
694 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
695 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
696 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
697 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
698 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
699 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
700 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
701 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
702 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704user <user name>
705 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
706 See also "uid" and "group".
707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200708node <name>
709 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
710
711 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
712 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
713 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
714 traffic.
715
716description <text>
717 Add a text that describes the instance.
718
719 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
720 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
721 "<" and ">" characters.
722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007243.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200725-----------------------
726
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200727max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
728 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
729 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
730 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
731 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
732 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
733 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
734 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
735 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
736
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200737maxconn <number>
738 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
739 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
740 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
741 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
742
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200743maxconnrate <number>
744 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
745 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
746 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
747 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
748 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
749 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
750 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
751 fairness.
752
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100753maxcomprate <number>
754 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300755 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100756 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
757 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
758 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
759 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
760 default value.
761
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100762maxcompcpuusage <number>
763 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
764 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
765 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
766 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
767 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
768 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
769 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
770 process down and from introducing high latencies.
771
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100772maxpipes <number>
773 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
774 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
775 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
776 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
777 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
778 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
779
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200780maxsessrate <number>
781 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
782 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
783 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
784 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
785 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
786 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
787 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
788 fairness.
789
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200790maxsslconn <number>
791 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
792 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
793 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
794 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
795 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
796 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
797 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
798
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200799maxsslrate <number>
800 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
801 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
802 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
803 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
804 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
805 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
806 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
807 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
808 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
809 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
810
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100811maxzlibmem <number>
812 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
813 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
814 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100815 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
816 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
817 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819noepoll
820 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
821 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100822 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823
824nokqueue
825 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
826 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
827 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
828
829nopoll
830 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
831 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100832 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100833 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200834
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100835nosplice
836 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
837 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
838 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100839 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100840 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
841 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
842 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
843 "option splice-response".
844
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300845nogetaddrinfo
846 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
847 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
848
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200849spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900850 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
851 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
852 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
853 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
854 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
855 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200856
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200857tune.bufsize <number>
858 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
859 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
860 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
861 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
862 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
863 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
864 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
865 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400866 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
867 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
868 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200869
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200870tune.chksize <number>
871 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
872 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
873 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
874 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
875 checks whenever possible.
876
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100877tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
878 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
879 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
880 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
881 this value. The default value is 1.
882
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100883tune.http.cookielen <number>
884 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
885 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
886 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
887 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
888 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
889 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
890 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
891 to change this value.
892
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200893tune.http.maxhdr <number>
894 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
895 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
896 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
897 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
898 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
899 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
900 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
901 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
902 limit too high.
903
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100904tune.idletimer <timeout>
905 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
906 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
907 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
908 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
909 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
910 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
911 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
912 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
913 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
914
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100915tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100916 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
917 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
918 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
919 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
920 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
921 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
922 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
923 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
924 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
925 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100926
927tune.maxpollevents <number>
928 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
929 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
930 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
931 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
932 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
933
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200934tune.maxrewrite <number>
935 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
936 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
937 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
938 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
939 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
940 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
941 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
942 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
943 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
944 bufsize.
945
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200946tune.pipesize <number>
947 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
948 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
949 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
950 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
951 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
952 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
953
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100954tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
955tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
956 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
957 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
958 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
959 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
960 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
961 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
962 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
963
964tune.sndbuf.client <number>
965tune.sndbuf.server <number>
966 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
967 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
968 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
969 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
970 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
971 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
972 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
973 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
974 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
975 notifying haproxy again.
976
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100977tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100978 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
979 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
980 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300981 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100982 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
983 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
984 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
985 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
986 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100987 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
988 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100989
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200990tune.ssl.force-private-cache
991 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
992 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
993 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
994 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
995 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
996 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
997
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100998tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
999 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001000 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001001 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1002 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1003 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1004 being used for too long.
1005
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001006tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1007 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1008 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1009 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1010 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1011 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1012 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1013 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1014 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1015 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1016 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001017 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1018 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001019
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001020tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1021 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001022 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001023 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1024 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1025 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1026
1027tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1028 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1029 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1030 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1031 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010333.3. Debugging
1034--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035
1036debug
1037 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1038 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1039 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1040 system startup.
1041
1042quiet
1043 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1044 line argument "-q".
1045
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010473.4. Userlists
1048--------------
1049It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1050http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1051it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1052
1053userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001054 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001055 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1056
1057group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001058 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001059 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1060 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1061
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001062user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1063 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001064 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1065 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001066 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1067 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001068 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001069 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001070
1071
1072 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001073 userlist L1
1074 group G1 users tiger,scott
1075 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001076
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001077 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1078 user scott insecure-password elgato
1079 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001080
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001081 userlist L2
1082 group G1
1083 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001084
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001085 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1086 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1087 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001088
1089 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001090
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001091
10923.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001093----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001094It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1095haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1096pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1097identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1098or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1099Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1100known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1101the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1102process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1103during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1104tables.
1105
1106peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001107 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001108 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1109
1110peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1111 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1112 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1113 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1114 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1115 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1116 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1117
1118 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1119 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1120
1121 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1122 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1123 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1124 across all peers.
1125
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001126 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1127 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1128 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1129
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001130 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001131 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001132 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1133 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1134 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001135
1136 backend mybackend
1137 mode tcp
1138 balance roundrobin
1139 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1140 stick on src
1141
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001142 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1143 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001144
1145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011464. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001147----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001148
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001149Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1150 - defaults <name>
1151 - frontend <name>
1152 - backend <name>
1153 - listen <name>
1154
1155A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1156its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1157section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001158section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001159
1160A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1161connections.
1162
1163A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1164to forward incoming connections.
1165
1166A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1167parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001169All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1170'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1171case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1172
1173Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1174logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1175proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1176However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1177name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1178
1179Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1180and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001181bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001182protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1183modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1184arbitrary criteria.
1185
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001186In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1187a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1188the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1189
1190 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1191 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1192 between responses and new requests.
1193
1194 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1195 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1196 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1197 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1198
1199 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1200 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1201 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1202
1203 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1204 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1205 client-facing connection remains open.
1206
1207 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1208 after the end of the response.
1209
1210The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1211frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1212following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1213weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1214
1215 Backend mode
1216
1217 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1218 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1219 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1220 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1221 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1222 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1223 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1224 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1225 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1226 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1227 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1228
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001229
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012314.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1232--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001234The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1235limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1236they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1237limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001238marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001239option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001240and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1241with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1242specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001243
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001244
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001245 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1246------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1247acl - X X X
1248appsession - - X X
1249backlog X X X -
1250balance X - X X
1251bind - X X -
1252bind-process X X X X
1253block - X X X
1254capture cookie - X X -
1255capture request header - X X -
1256capture response header - X X -
1257clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001258compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001259contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1260cookie X - X X
1261default-server X - X X
1262default_backend X X X -
1263description - X X X
1264disabled X X X X
1265dispatch - - X X
1266enabled X X X X
1267errorfile X X X X
1268errorloc X X X X
1269errorloc302 X X X X
1270-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1271errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001272force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001273fullconn X - X X
1274grace X X X X
1275hash-type X - X X
1276http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001277http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001278http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001279http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001280http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001281http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001282id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001283ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001284log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001285max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001286maxconn X X X -
1287mode X X X X
1288monitor fail - X X -
1289monitor-net X X X -
1290monitor-uri X X X -
1291option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1292option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1293option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1294option allbackups (*) X - X X
1295option checkcache (*) X - X X
1296option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1297option contstats (*) X X X -
1298option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1299option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1300option forceclose (*) X X X X
1301-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1302option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001303option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001304option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001305option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001306option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001307option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001308option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1309option httpchk X - X X
1310option httpclose (*) X X X X
1311option httplog X X X X
1312option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001313option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001314option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001315option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1316option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1317option logasap (*) X X X -
1318option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001319option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001320option nolinger (*) X X X X
1321option originalto X X X X
1322option persist (*) X - X X
1323option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001324option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001325option smtpchk X - X X
1326option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1327option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1328option splice-request (*) X X X X
1329option splice-response (*) X X X X
1330option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1331option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1332-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001333option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001334option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1335option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1336option tcpka X X X X
1337option tcplog X X X X
1338option transparent (*) X - X X
1339persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1340rate-limit sessions X X X -
1341redirect - X X X
1342redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1343redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1344reqadd - X X X
1345reqallow - X X X
1346reqdel - X X X
1347reqdeny - X X X
1348reqiallow - X X X
1349reqidel - X X X
1350reqideny - X X X
1351reqipass - X X X
1352reqirep - X X X
1353reqisetbe - X X X
1354reqitarpit - X X X
1355reqpass - X X X
1356reqrep - X X X
1357-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1358reqsetbe - X X X
1359reqtarpit - X X X
1360retries X - X X
1361rspadd - X X X
1362rspdel - X X X
1363rspdeny - X X X
1364rspidel - X X X
1365rspideny - X X X
1366rspirep - X X X
1367rsprep - X X X
1368server - - X X
1369source X - X X
1370srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001371stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001372stats auth X - X X
1373stats enable X - X X
1374stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001375stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001376stats realm X - X X
1377stats refresh X - X X
1378stats scope X - X X
1379stats show-desc X - X X
1380stats show-legends X - X X
1381stats show-node X - X X
1382stats uri X - X X
1383-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1384stick match - - X X
1385stick on - - X X
1386stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001387stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001388stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001389tcp-check connect - - X X
1390tcp-check expect - - X X
1391tcp-check send - - X X
1392tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001393tcp-request connection - X X -
1394tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001395tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001396tcp-response content - - X X
1397tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001398timeout check X - X X
1399timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001400timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001401timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1402timeout connect X - X X
1403timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1404timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1405timeout http-request X X X X
1406timeout queue X - X X
1407timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001408timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001409timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1410timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001411timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001412transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001413unique-id-format X X X -
1414unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001415use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001416use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001417------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1418 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001419
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014214.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1422---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001423
1424This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1425
1426
1427acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1428 Declare or complete an access list.
1429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1430 no | yes | yes | yes
1431 Example:
1432 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1433 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1434 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1435
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001436 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001437
1438
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001439appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1440 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001441 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1443 no | no | yes | yes
1444 Arguments :
1445 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1446 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1447
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001448 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001449 checked in each cookie value.
1450
1451 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1452 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1453 milliseconds.
1454
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001455 request-learn
1456 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1457 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1458 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1459 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1460 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1461 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1462
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001463 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1464 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1465 data following this prefix.
1466
1467 Example :
1468 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1469
1470 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1471 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1472
1473 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1474 2 modes are currently supported :
1475 - path-parameters :
1476 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1477 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1478 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1479 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1480 - query-string :
1481 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1482 query string.
1483
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001484 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1485 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1486 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1487 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001488 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1489 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1490 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001491 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1492 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1493
1494 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1495
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001496 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1497 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1498 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1499
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001500 Example :
1501 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1502
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001503 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1504 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001505
1506
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001507backlog <conns>
1508 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1510 yes | yes | yes | no
1511 Arguments :
1512 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1513 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001514 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001515
1516 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1517 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1518 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1519 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1520 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1521 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1522 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1523 backlog parameter.
1524
1525 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1526 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1527 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1528
1529 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1530
1531
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001532balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001533balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001534 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1536 yes | no | yes | yes
1537 Arguments :
1538 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1539 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1540 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1541 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1542
1543 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1544 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1545 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1546 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001547 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001548 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001549 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1550 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1551 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1552 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1553 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1554 it, so that you don't worry.
1555
1556 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1557 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1558 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1559 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1560 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1561 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1562 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1563 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001564
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001565 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1566 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1567 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1568 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1569 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1570 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1571 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1572 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1573
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001574 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001575 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001576 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1577 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001578 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001579 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1580 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1581 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1582 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1583 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001584 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1585 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1586 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1587 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1588 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1589 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001591 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1592 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1593 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1594 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1595 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1596 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1597 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1598 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001599 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001600 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001601 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1602 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1603 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001604
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001605 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1606 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1607 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1608 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1609 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1610 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1611 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1612 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1613 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1614 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1615 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1616 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001617
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001618 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001619 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1620 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1621 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1622 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1623 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1624 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1625 URIs start with a leading "/".
1626
1627 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1628 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1629 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1630 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1631
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001632 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001633 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1634
1635 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001636 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1637 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001638 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1639 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1640 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1641 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001642 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001643 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1644 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001645
1646 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1647 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1648 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1649 server will receive the request.
1650
1651 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1652 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1653 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1654 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1655 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001656 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1657 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1658 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001659
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001660 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1661 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1662 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1663 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1664 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001666 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001667 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1668 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1669 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1670
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001671 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1672 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1673 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1674
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001675 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001676 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001677 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1678 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1679 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1680 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1681 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1682 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001683 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001684 used instead.
1685
1686 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1687 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1688 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1689 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1690
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001691 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1692 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1693 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1694
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001695 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001696
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001697 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001698 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1699 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001700
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001701 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1702 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1703 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001704
1705 Examples :
1706 balance roundrobin
1707 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001708 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001709 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1710 balance hdr(host)
1711 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001712
1713 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1714 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001716 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001717 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1718 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1719 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1720 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1721
1722 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1723 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1724 defaults to 16 kB.
1725
1726 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1727 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1728
1729 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1730 Round Robin.
1731
1732 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1733 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1734 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1735 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1736
1737 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1738
1739 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001740 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001741 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1742 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1743 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001744
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001745 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1746 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001747
1748
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001749bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1750bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001751 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1753 no | yes | yes | no
1754 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001755 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1756 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1757 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1758 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001759 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001760 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1761 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1762 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1763 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1764 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1765 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1766 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02001767 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001768 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1769 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1770 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001771 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1772 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1773 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1774 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001775
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001776 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1777 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001778 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1779 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1780 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001781 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1782 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1783 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1784 the range.
1785
1786 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1787 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1788 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1789 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1790 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1791 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1792 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001793 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001794 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001795
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001796 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1797 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1798 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1799 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1800 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1801 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1802 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1803 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1804
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001805 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1806 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1807 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1808 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001809
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001810 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1811 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1812 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1813 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1814 in a frontend.
1815
1816 Example :
1817 listen http_proxy
1818 bind :80,:443
1819 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001820 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001821
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001822 listen http_https_proxy
1823 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001824 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001825
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001826 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1827 bind ipv6@:80
1828 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1829 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1830
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001831 listen external_bind_app1
1832 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1833
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001834 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001835 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001836
1837
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001838bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001839 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1841 yes | yes | yes | yes
1842 Arguments :
1843 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1844 may be used to override a default value.
1845
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001846 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001847 option may be combined with other numbers.
1848
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001849 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001850 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1851 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1852 missing from all processes.
1853
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001854 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001855 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001856 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1857 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1858 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1859 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001860
1861 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1862 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1863 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1864 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1865 and 'even' instances.
1866
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001867 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1868 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1869 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1870 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001871
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001872 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1873 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1874
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001875 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1876 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1877
1878 Example :
1879 listen app_ip1
1880 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001881 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001882
1883 listen app_ip2
1884 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001885 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001886
1887 listen management
1888 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001889 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001890
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001891 listen management
1892 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1893 bind-process 1-4
1894
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001895 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001896
1897
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001898block { if | unless } <condition>
1899 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1901 no | yes | yes | yes
1902
1903 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1904 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001905 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001906 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001907 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1908 "block" statements per instance.
1909
1910 Example:
1911 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1912 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1913 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1914 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001916 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001917
1918
1919capture cookie <name> len <length>
1920 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1922 no | yes | yes | no
1923 Arguments :
1924 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1925 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1926 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1927 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1928 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1929
1930 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1931 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1932 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1933 right if it exceeds <length>.
1934
1935 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1936 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1937 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1938 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1939
1940 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1941 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1942 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1943
1944 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1945 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1946 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001947 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1948 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1949 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001950
1951 Example:
1952 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1953
1954 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001955 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001956
1957
1958capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001959 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1961 no | yes | yes | no
1962 Arguments :
1963 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001964 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001965 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1966 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1967 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1968
1969 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1970 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1971 it exceeds <length>.
1972
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001973 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001974 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1975 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001976 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1977 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1978 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1979 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001980 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001981 environments to find where the request came from.
1982
1983 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1984 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1985 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1986 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001987
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001988 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1989 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1990 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1991 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1992 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001993
1994 Example:
1995 capture request header Host len 15
1996 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1997 capture request header Referrer len 15
1998
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001999 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002000 about logging.
2001
2002
2003capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002004 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2006 no | yes | yes | no
2007 Arguments :
2008 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002009 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002010 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2011 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2012 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2013
2014 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2015 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2016 it exceeds <length>.
2017
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002018 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002019 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2020 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2021 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002022 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2023 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2024 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2025 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002026
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002027 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2028 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2029 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2030 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2031 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002032
2033 Example:
2034 capture response header Content-length len 9
2035 capture response header Location len 15
2036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002037 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002038 about logging.
2039
2040
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002041clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002042 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2044 yes | yes | yes | no
2045 Arguments :
2046 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2047 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2048 as explained at the top of this document.
2049
2050 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2051 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2052 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2053 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2054 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2055 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2056 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2057 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002058 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002059 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2060 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2061
2062 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2063 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2064 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2065 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2066 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2067 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2068
2069 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2070 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2071
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002072 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2073 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002074
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002075compression algo <algorithm> ...
2076compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002077compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002078 Enable HTTP compression.
2079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2080 yes | yes | yes | yes
2081 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002082 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2083 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2084 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2085
2086 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002087 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002088 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2089 data.
2090
2091 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2092 support for zlib was built in.
2093
2094 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2095 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2096 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2097 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2098 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2099 in.
2100
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002101 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002102 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002103 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2104 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2105 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2106 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2107 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002108
2109 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2110 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2111 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2112 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2113 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002114 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2115 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2116 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2117 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2118 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2119 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002120
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002121 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002122 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2123 "Accept-Encoding" header
2124 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002125 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002126 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2127 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002128 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2129 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2130 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2131 "multipart"
2132 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2133 header
2134 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2135 and later
2136 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2137 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002138
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002139 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2140 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002141
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002142 Examples :
2143 compression algo gzip
2144 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002145
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002146contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002147 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2149 yes | no | yes | yes
2150 Arguments :
2151 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2152 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2153 as explained at the top of this document.
2154
2155 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002156 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002157 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002158 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2159 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2160 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2161 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2162
2163 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2164 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2165 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2166 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2167 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2168 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2169
2170 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2171 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2172 instead.
2173
2174 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2175 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2176
2177
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002178cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002179 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2180 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002181 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2183 yes | no | yes | yes
2184 Arguments :
2185 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2186 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2187 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2188 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2189 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2190 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2191 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2192 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2193 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2194
2195 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2196 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2197 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2198 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2199 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2200 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2201 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2202 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2203 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2204 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2205 "insert" and "prefix".
2206
2207 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002208 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002209
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002210 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002211 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2212 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2213 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2214 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2215 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2216 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2217 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2218 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2219 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2220 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002221
2222 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2223 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2224 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2225 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2226 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2227 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2228 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2229 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2230 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2231 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002232 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2233 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2234 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002235
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002236 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2237 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2238 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002239 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2240 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2241 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2242 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002243 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2244 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2245 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002246
2247 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2248 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2249 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2250 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2251 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2252 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2253 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2254 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2255 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2256
2257 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2258 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2259 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2260 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2261 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2262 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2263 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2264 persistence cookie in the cache.
2265 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2266
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002267 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2268 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2269 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2270 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2271 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2272 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2273 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2274 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2275 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2276 they logout.
2277
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002278 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2279 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2280 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2281 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2282
2283 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2284 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2285 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2286 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2287 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2288 this attribute.
2289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002290 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002291 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002292 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2293 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2294 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2295 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2296 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2297 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002298
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002299 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2300 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2301 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2302 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2303 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2304 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2305 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2306 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2307 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2308 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2309 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2310 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2311 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2312 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2313 the site.
2314
2315 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2316 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2317 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2318 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2319 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2320 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2321 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2322 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2323 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2324 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2325 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2326 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2327 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2328 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2329 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2330 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2331
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002332 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2333 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2334 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2335 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002336
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002337 Examples :
2338 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2339 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2340 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002341 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002343 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002344 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002345
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002347default-server [param*]
2348 Change default options for a server in a backend
2349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2350 yes | no | yes | yes
2351 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002352 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2353 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2354 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2355 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002356
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002357 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002358 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2359
2360 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002361
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002362
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002363default_backend <backend>
2364 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2366 yes | yes | yes | no
2367 Arguments :
2368 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2369
2370 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2371 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2372 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2373 will catch all undetermined requests.
2374
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002375 Example :
2376
2377 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2378 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2379 default_backend dynamic
2380
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002381 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2382
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002383
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002384description <string>
2385 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2387 no | yes | yes | yes
2388 Arguments : string
2389
2390 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2391 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2392 it describes.
2393 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2394
2395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002396disabled
2397 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2399 yes | yes | yes | yes
2400 Arguments : none
2401
2402 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2403 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2404 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2405 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2406 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2407 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2408 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2409
2410 See also : "enabled"
2411
2412
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002413dispatch <address>:<port>
2414 Set a default server address
2415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2416 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002417 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002418
2419 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2420 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2421 during start-up.
2422
2423 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2424 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2425 possible with normal servers.
2426
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002427 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002428 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2429 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2430 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2431 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2432
2433 See also : "server"
2434
2435
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436enabled
2437 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2439 yes | yes | yes | yes
2440 Arguments : none
2441
2442 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2443 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2444
2445 See also : "disabled"
2446
2447
2448errorfile <code> <file>
2449 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2451 yes | yes | yes | yes
2452 Arguments :
2453 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002454 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002455
2456 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002457 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002458 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002459 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2460 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461
2462 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2463 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2464 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2465
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002466 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2467
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002468 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2469 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2470 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2471 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2472
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002473 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2474 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2475 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2476 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2477 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2478 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2479
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002480 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2481 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2482 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002483 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002484 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2485
2486 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2487
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002488 Example :
2489 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2490 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2491 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2492
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002493
2494errorloc <code> <url>
2495errorloc302 <code> <url>
2496 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2498 yes | yes | yes | yes
2499 Arguments :
2500 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002501 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002502
2503 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2504 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2505 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2506 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2507 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2508
2509 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2510 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2511 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2512
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002513 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2514
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002515 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2516 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2517 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2518 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2519 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2520 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2521 request.
2522
2523 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2524
2525
2526errorloc303 <code> <url>
2527 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2529 yes | yes | yes | yes
2530 Arguments :
2531 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2532 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2533
2534 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2535 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2536 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2537 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2538 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2539
2540 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2541 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2542 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2543
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002544 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2545
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002546 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2547 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2548 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2549 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002550 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002551
2552 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2553
2554
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002555force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2556 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2557 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2558 no | yes | yes | yes
2559
2560 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2561 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2562 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2563 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2564 marked down for maintenance operations.
2565
2566 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2567 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2568 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2569 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2570 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2571 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2572 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2573 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2574 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2575
2576 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2577 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2578 is used.
2579
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002580 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002581 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002582
2583
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002584fullconn <conns>
2585 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2587 yes | no | yes | yes
2588 Arguments :
2589 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2590 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2591
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002592 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002593 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002594 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002595 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2596 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2597 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2598 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2599 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002600 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002601
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002602 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2603 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002604 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2605 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2606 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002607
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002608 Example :
2609 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2610 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2611 # connections.
2612 backend dynamic
2613 fullconn 10000
2614 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2615 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2616
2617 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2618
2619
2620grace <time>
2621 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002623 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002624 Arguments :
2625 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2626 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2627 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2628
2629 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2630 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002631 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002632 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2633
2634 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2635 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2636 simplify it.
2637
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002638
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002639hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002640 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2642 yes | no | yes | yes
2643 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002644 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2645 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002646
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002647 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2648 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2649 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2650 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2651 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2652 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2653 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2654 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2655 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2656 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002657
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002658 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2659 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2660 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2661 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2662 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2663 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2664 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2665 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2666 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2667 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2668 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2669 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2670 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002671 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2672 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002673
2674 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2675
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002676 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002677 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2678 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2679 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002680 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2681 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2682 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002683
2684 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2685 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002686 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2687 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2688 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2689 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2690
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002691 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2692 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2693 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2694 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2695 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2696 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2697 parameter.
2698
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002699 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2700
2701 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2702 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2703 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2704 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2705 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2706 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2707 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2708 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2709 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2710 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2711 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2712 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002713
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002714 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2715 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2716 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002717
2718 See also : "balance", "server"
2719
2720
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002721http-check disable-on-404
2722 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002724 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002725 Arguments : none
2726
2727 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2728 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2729 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2730 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2731 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2732 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2733 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2734 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002735 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2736 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2737 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2738
2739 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2740
2741
2742http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002743 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002745 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002746 Arguments :
2747 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2748 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002749 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002750 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2751 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2752 details on the supported keywords.
2753
2754 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2755 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2756 with the usual backslash ('\').
2757
2758 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2759 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2760 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2761 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2762 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2763
2764 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002765 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002766 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2767 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2768 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2769
2770 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002771 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002772 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2773 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2774 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2775 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2776
2777 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002778 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002779 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2780 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2781 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2782 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2783 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2784 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2785 trace).
2786
2787 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002788 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002789 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2790 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2791 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2792 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2793 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2794 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2795
2796 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2797 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2798 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2799 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2800 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2801 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2802 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2803 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2804
2805 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2806 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2807
2808 Examples :
2809 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002810 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002811
2812 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002813 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002814
2815 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002816 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002817
2818 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002819 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002820
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002821 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002822
2823
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002824http-check send-state
2825 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2827 yes | no | yes | yes
2828 Arguments : none
2829
2830 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2831 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2832 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2833 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2834 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2835
2836 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2837 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2838 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2839 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2840 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2841 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2842 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2843 checked in multiple backends.
2844
2845 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2846 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2847
2848 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2849 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2850 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2851 one fails.
2852
2853 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2854 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2855 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2856
2857 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2858 server's queue.
2859
2860 Example of a header received by the application server :
2861 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2862 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2863
2864 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2865
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002866http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002867 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002868 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002869 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2870 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2871 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2872 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2873 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2874 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002875 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002876 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2877
2878 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2879 no | yes | yes | yes
2880
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002881 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2882 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2883 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2884 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2885 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002886
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002887 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2888 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2889 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2890
2891 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2892 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2893 are evaluated.
2894
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002895 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2896 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2897 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2898 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2899 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2900 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2901 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2902 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2903 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002904 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002905 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2906
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002907 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2908 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2909 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2910 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2911 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2912
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002913 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2914 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2915 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002916 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2917 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002918
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002919 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2920 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2921 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2922 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2923 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2924 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2925 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2926 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2927
2928 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2929 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2930 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2931 external users.
2932
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002933 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2934 <name>.
2935
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002936 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2937 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2938 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2939 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2940 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2941 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2942 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2943 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2944
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002945 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2946 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2947 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2948 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2949 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2950 another equipment.
2951
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002952 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2953 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2954 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2955 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2956 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2957 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2958 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2959 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2960
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002961 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2962 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2963 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2964 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2965 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2966 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2967 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2968 admin privileges.
2969
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002970 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
2971 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
2972 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2973 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
2974 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
2975 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
2976 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
2977 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2978
2979 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
2980 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
2981 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2982 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
2983 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
2984 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2985
2986 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
2987 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
2988 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2989 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
2990 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
2991 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2992
2993 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
2994 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
2995 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
2996 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
2997 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
2998 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
2999 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3000 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3001 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3002
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003003 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3004
3005 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3006 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3007 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3008 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003009
3010 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003011 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3012 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3013 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003014
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003015 http-request allow if nagios
3016 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3017 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3018 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003019
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003020 Example:
3021 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003022 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003023
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003024 Example:
3025 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3026 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3027 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3028 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3029 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3030 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3031 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3032 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3033 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3034
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003035 Example:
3036 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3037 acl add path /addacl
3038 acl del path /delacl
3039
3040 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3041
3042 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3043 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3044
3045 Example:
3046 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3047 acl setmap path /setmap
3048 acl delmap path /delmap
3049
3050 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3051
3052 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3053 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3054
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003055 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3056 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003057
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003058http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003059 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003060 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3061 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3062 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3063 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3064 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3065 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003066 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003067 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3068
3069 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3070 no | yes | yes | yes
3071
3072 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3073 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3074 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3075 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3076 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3077 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3078
3079 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3080 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3081 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3082 current section.
3083
3084 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3085 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3086 rules are evaluated.
3087
3088 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3089 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3090 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3091 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3092 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3093 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3094 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3095
3096 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3097 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3098 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3099 external users.
3100
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003101 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3102 <name>.
3103
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003104 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3105 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3106 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3107 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3108 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3109 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3110 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3111 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3112
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003113 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3114 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3115 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3116 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3117 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3118 another equipment.
3119
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003120 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3121 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3122 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3123 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3124 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3125 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3126 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3127 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3128
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003129 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3130 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3131 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3132 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3133 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3134 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3135 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3136 admin privileges.
3137
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003138 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3139 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3140 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3141 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3142 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3143 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3144 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3145 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3146
3147 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3148 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3149 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3150 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3151 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3152 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3153
3154 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3155 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3156 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3157 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3158 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3159 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3160
3161 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3162 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3163 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3164 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3165 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3166 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3167 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3168 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3169 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3170
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003171 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3172
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003173 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003174 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3175 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3176 rules.
3177
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003178 Example:
3179 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3180
3181 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3182
3183 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3184 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3185
3186 Example:
3187 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3188
3189 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3190
3191 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3192 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3193
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003194 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3195 ACL usage.
3196
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003197
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003198http-send-name-header [<header>]
3199 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3200
3201 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3202 yes | no | yes | yes
3203
3204 Arguments :
3205
3206 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3207
3208 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3209 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3210 is added with the header string proved.
3211
3212 See also : "server"
3213
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003214id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003215 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3217 no | yes | yes | yes
3218 Arguments : none
3219
3220 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3221 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3222 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003223
3224
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003225ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3226 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3227 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3228 no | yes | yes | yes
3229
3230 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3231 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3232 and running).
3233
3234 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3235 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3236 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003237 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003238 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3239
3240 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3241 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3242
3243 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3244 "unless" condition is met.
3245
3246 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3247
3248
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003249log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003250log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003251no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003252 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3254 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003255
3256 Prefix :
3257 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3258 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3259 prefix does not allow arguments.
3260
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003261 Arguments :
3262 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3263 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3264 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3265 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3266 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3267 parameter.
3268
3269 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3270 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3271
3272 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3273 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3274 standard syslog port).
3275
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003276 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3277 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3278 standard syslog port).
3279
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003280 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3281 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3282 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3283 appropriately writeable).
3284
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003285 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3286 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3287 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3288 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3289
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003290 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3291
3292 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3293 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3294 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3295
3296 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3297 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3298 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003299 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3300 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3301 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3302 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3303 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003304
3305 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3306
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003307 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3308 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3309 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003310
3311 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3312 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3313 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3314 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3315
3316 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3317 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003318
3319 Example :
3320 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003321 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3322 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003323 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3324
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003325
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003326log-format <string>
3327 Allows you to custom a log line.
3328
3329 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3330
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003331
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003332max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3333 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3334 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3335 yes | no | yes | yes
3336
3337 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3338 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3339 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3340 servers.
3341
3342 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3343 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3344 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3345 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3346 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3347 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3348 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3349 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3350 picking a different server.
3351
3352 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3353 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3354 even if they have to be queued.
3355
3356 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3357 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3358
3359
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003360maxconn <conns>
3361 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3363 yes | yes | yes | no
3364 Arguments :
3365 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3366 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3367 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3368 closes.
3369
3370 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3371 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3372 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3373 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3374 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3375 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3376 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3377 properly tuned.
3378
3379 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3380 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3381 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3382
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003383 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3384
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003385 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3386
3387
3388mode { tcp|http|health }
3389 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3391 yes | yes | yes | yes
3392 Arguments :
3393 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3394 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3395 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3396 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3397
3398 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3399 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3400 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3401 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3402 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3403
3404 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003405 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3406 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3407 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3408 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3409 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3410 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3411 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003412
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003413 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3414 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3415 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003416
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003417 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003418 defaults http_instances
3419 mode http
3420
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003421 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003422
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003423
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003424monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003425 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3427 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003428 Arguments :
3429 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3430 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003431 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003432 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3433 backend and its backup.
3434
3435 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3436 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3437 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3438 servers in a list of backends.
3439
3440 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3441 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3442 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3443 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3444 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3445 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3446 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003447 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3448 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003449
3450 Example:
3451 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003452 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003453 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3454 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3455 monitor-uri /site_alive
3456 monitor fail if site_dead
3457
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003458 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003459
3460
3461monitor-net <source>
3462 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3464 yes | yes | yes | no
3465 Arguments :
3466 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3467 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3468 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3469 followed by a mask.
3470
3471 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3472 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003473 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003474 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3475
3476 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3477 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3478 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3479 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003480 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3481 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3482 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003483
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003484 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3485 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3486 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3487 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3488 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3489 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003490
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003491 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3492 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003493
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003494 Example :
3495 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3496 frontend www
3497 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3498
3499 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3500
3501
3502monitor-uri <uri>
3503 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3505 yes | yes | yes | no
3506 Arguments :
3507 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3508 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3509
3510 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3511 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3512 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3513 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3514 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3515 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3516 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3517 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3518
3519 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3520 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3521 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3522 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3523 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3524 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3525
3526 Example :
3527 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3528 frontend www
3529 mode http
3530 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3531
3532 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3533
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003534
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003535option abortonclose
3536no option abortonclose
3537 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3539 yes | no | yes | yes
3540 Arguments : none
3541
3542 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3543 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3544 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3545 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003546 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003547 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3548 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3549 encountered while delivering the response.
3550
3551 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3552 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3553 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3554 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3555 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3556 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003557 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003558 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003559 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003560 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3561 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3562 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3563
3564 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3565 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3566 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3567 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3568 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3569 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3570 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3571 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003572 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003573
3574 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3575 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3576
3577 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3578
3579
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003580option accept-invalid-http-request
3581no option accept-invalid-http-request
3582 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3584 yes | yes | yes | no
3585 Arguments : none
3586
3587 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3588 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3589 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3590 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3591 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3592 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3593 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3594 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003595 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3596 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3597 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3598 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3599 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3600 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003601
3602 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3603 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3604 been confirmed.
3605
3606 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3607 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003608 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3609 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003610 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3611
3612 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3613 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3614
3615 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3616 stats socket.
3617
3618
3619option accept-invalid-http-response
3620no option accept-invalid-http-response
3621 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3623 yes | no | yes | yes
3624 Arguments : none
3625
3626 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3627 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3628 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3629 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3630 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3631 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3632 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3633 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3634 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3635
3636 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3637 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3638 been confirmed.
3639
3640 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3641 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3642 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3643 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3644
3645 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3646 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3647
3648 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3649 stats socket.
3650
3651
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003652option allbackups
3653no option allbackups
3654 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3656 yes | no | yes | yes
3657 Arguments : none
3658
3659 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3660 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3661 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3662 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3663 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3664 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3665 order between the backup servers anymore.
3666
3667 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3668 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3669
3670 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3671 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3672
3673
3674option checkcache
3675no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003676 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3678 yes | no | yes | yes
3679 Arguments : none
3680
3681 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3682 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003683 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003684 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3685 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003686 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003687
3688 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003689 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003690 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003691 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3692 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003693 to the client are :
3694 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003695 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003696 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003697 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3698 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3699 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3700 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3701 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3702 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3703 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3704 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3705 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3706 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3707 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3708
3709 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003710 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003711 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003712 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003713 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3714
3715 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3716 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003717 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003718 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3719
3720 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3721 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3722
3723
3724option clitcpka
3725no option clitcpka
3726 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3728 yes | yes | yes | no
3729 Arguments : none
3730
3731 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3732 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3733 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3734 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3735
3736 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3737 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3738 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3739 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3740
3741 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3742 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3743 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3744 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3745 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3746
3747 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3748
3749 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3750 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3751 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3752
3753 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3754 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3755
3756 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3757
3758
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003759option contstats
3760 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3762 yes | yes | yes | no
3763 Arguments : none
3764
3765 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3766 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3767 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3768 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3769 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3770 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3771 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3772
3773
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003774option dontlog-normal
3775no option dontlog-normal
3776 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3778 yes | yes | yes | no
3779 Arguments : none
3780
3781 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3782 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3783 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3784 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3785 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3786 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3787 logged.
3788
3789 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3790 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3791 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003793 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003794 logging.
3795
3796
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003797option dontlognull
3798no option dontlognull
3799 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3801 yes | yes | yes | no
3802 Arguments : none
3803
3804 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3805 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3806 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3807 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3808 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3809 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3810 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3811
3812 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3813 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3814 would not be logged.
3815
3816 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3817 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003819 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003820
3821
3822option forceclose
3823no option forceclose
3824 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003826 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003827 Arguments : none
3828
3829 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3830 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3831 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3832 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3833 global session times in the logs.
3834
3835 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003836 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003837 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003838
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003839 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3840 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3841 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3842
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003843 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3844 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003845
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003846 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3847 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3848
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003849 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003850
3851
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003852option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003853 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3855 yes | yes | yes | yes
3856 Arguments :
3857 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3858 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003859 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003860 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003861
3862 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3863 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3864 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3865 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3866 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3867 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3868 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003869 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3870 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3871 possible that the client has already brought one.
3872
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003873 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003874 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003875 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3876 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003877 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3878 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003879
3880 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3881 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3882 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3883 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3884 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3885 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3886 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3887
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003888 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3889 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3890 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3891 are under the control of the end-user.
3892
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003893 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003894 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3895 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003896 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3897 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3898 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003899
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003900 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003901 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3902 frontend www
3903 mode http
3904 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3905
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003906 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3907 backend www
3908 mode http
3909 option forwardfor header X-Client
3910
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003911 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003912 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003913
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003914
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003915option http-keep-alive
3916no option http-keep-alive
3917 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3919 yes | yes | yes | yes
3920 Arguments : none
3921
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003922 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
3923 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
3924 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
3925 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
3926 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
3927 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
3928 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
3929
3930 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
3931 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003932 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3933 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3934 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3935 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3936 situations where this option may be useful :
3937
3938 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3939 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3940
3941 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3942 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3943
3944 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3945 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3946 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3947 request.
3948
3949 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3950 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003951 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3952 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3953 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003954
3955 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3956 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3957
3958 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3959 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3960 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3961 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3962 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3963 not set.
3964
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003965 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3966 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003967 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003968 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003969
3970 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003971 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3972 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003973
3974
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003975option http-no-delay
3976no option http-no-delay
3977 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3979 yes | yes | yes | yes
3980 Arguments : none
3981
3982 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3983 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3984 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3985 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3986 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3987 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3988 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3989 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3990 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3991 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3992 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3993 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3994 affected.
3995
3996 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3997 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3998 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3999 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4000 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4001 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4002 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4003 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4004 latency environments.
4005
4006
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004007option http-pretend-keepalive
4008no option http-pretend-keepalive
4009 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4011 yes | yes | yes | yes
4012 Arguments : none
4013
4014 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4015 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4016 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4017 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4018 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4019 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4020 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4021 consider the response complete.
4022
4023 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4024 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4025 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4026 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4027 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4028 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4029
4030 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4031 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4032 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4033 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4034 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4035 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4036 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4037
4038 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4039 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004040 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004041 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4042 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004043
4044 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4045 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4046
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004047 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4048 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004049
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004050
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004051option http-server-close
4052no option http-server-close
4053 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4055 yes | yes | yes | yes
4056 Arguments : none
4057
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004058 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4059 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4060 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4061 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4062 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4063 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4064 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4065 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4066 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4067 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4068 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4069 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4070 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4071 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4072 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4073 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004074
4075 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4076 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4077 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4078 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004079 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4080 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004081
4082 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4083 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004084 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4085 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004086 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4087 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004088
4089 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4090 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4091
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004092 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004093 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4094 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004095
4096
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004097option http-tunnel
4098no option http-tunnel
4099 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4101 yes | yes | yes | yes
4102 Arguments : none
4103
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004104 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4105 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4106 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4107 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4108 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4109 "option http-tunnel".
4110
4111 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004112 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004113 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4114 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4115 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4116 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4117 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4118 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4119 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004120
4121 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4122 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4123
4124 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4125 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4126 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4127
4128
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004129option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004130no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004131 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4133 yes | yes | yes | no
4134 Arguments : none
4135
4136 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4137 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4138 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4139 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4140 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4141 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4142 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4143
4144 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4145 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4146 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4147 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4148 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4149 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4150 request along its whole life.
4151
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004152 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4153 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4154 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4155 front of an existing proxy.
4156
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004157 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4158
4159 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4160 http-server-close".
4161
4162
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004163option httpchk
4164option httpchk <uri>
4165option httpchk <method> <uri>
4166option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4167 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4169 yes | no | yes | yes
4170 Arguments :
4171 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4172 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4173 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4174 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4175 ones.
4176
4177 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4178 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4179 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4180
4181 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4182 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4183 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4184 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4185 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4186
4187 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4188 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4189 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4190 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4191 the lack of any response.
4192
4193 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4194
4195 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4196 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4197 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4198
4199 Examples :
4200 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4201 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4202 backend https_relay
4203 mode tcp
4204 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4205 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4206
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004207 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4208 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4209 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004210
4211
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004212option httpclose
4213no option httpclose
4214 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4216 yes | yes | yes | yes
4217 Arguments : none
4218
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004219 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4220 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4221 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4222 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004223 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004224 "option http-tunnel".
4225
4226 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4227 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4228 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4229 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4230 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4231 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4232 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4233 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004234
4235 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004236 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004237 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4238 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4239 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4240 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4241 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004242
4243 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4244 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004245 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4246 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004247 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4248 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004249
4250 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4251 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4252
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004253 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4254 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004255
4256
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004257option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004258 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4260 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004261 Arguments :
4262 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4263 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4264 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4265 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4266 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004267
4268 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4269 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4270 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4271 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4272 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4273 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4274 ports.
4275
4276 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4277
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004278 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4279 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4280 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4281 by default.
4282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004283 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004284
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004285
4286option http_proxy
4287no option http_proxy
4288 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4290 yes | yes | yes | yes
4291 Arguments : none
4292
4293 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4294 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4295 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4296 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4297 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4298
4299 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4300 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4301 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4302 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004303 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004304 be analyzed.
4305
4306 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4307 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4308
4309 Example :
4310 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4311 backend direct_forward
4312 option httpclose
4313 option http_proxy
4314
4315 See also : "option httpclose"
4316
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004317
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004318option independent-streams
4319no option independent-streams
4320 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4322 yes | yes | yes | yes
4323 Arguments : none
4324
4325 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4326 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4327 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4328 receive data or not.
4329
4330 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4331 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4332 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4333 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4334 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4335 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4336 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4337 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4338 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4339 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4340 socket buffers.
4341
4342 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4343 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4344 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4345 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4346 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4347
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004348 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004349 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4350 deprecated.
4351
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004352 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004353
4354
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004355option ldap-check
4356 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4358 yes | no | yes | yes
4359 Arguments : none
4360
4361 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4362 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4363 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4364 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4365
4366 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4367 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4368
4369 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4370 configure it.
4371
4372 Example :
4373 option ldap-check
4374
4375 See also : "option httpchk"
4376
4377
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004378option log-health-checks
4379no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004380 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4382 yes | no | yes | yes
4383 Arguments : none
4384
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004385 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4386 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4387 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004388
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004389 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4390 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4391 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4392 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4393 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4394
4395 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4396 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004397
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004398 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4399 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4400 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004401
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004402
4403option log-separate-errors
4404no option log-separate-errors
4405 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4407 yes | yes | yes | no
4408 Arguments : none
4409
4410 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4411 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4412 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4413 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4414 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4415 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4416 provides very important information.
4417
4418 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4419 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4420 error logs.
4421
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004422 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004423 logging.
4424
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004425
4426option logasap
4427no option logasap
4428 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4430 yes | yes | yes | no
4431 Arguments : none
4432
4433 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4434 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4435 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4436 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4437 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4438 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4439 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004440 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004441 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4442 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4443
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004444 Examples :
4445 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4446 mode http
4447 option httplog
4448 option logasap
4449 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4450
4451 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4452 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4453 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4454 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4455
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004456 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004457 logging.
4458
4459
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004460option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4461 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4463 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004464 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004465 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4466 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004467
4468 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4469 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4470 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4471 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4472 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4473 in the MySQL table, like this :
4474
4475 USE mysql;
4476 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4477 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4478
4479 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4480 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4481 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4482 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4483 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4484 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4485 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4486 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4487 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4488
4489 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4490 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004491
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004492 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004493
4494 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4495 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4496 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4497 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4498 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4499 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4500
4501 See also: "option httpchk"
4502
4503
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004504option nolinger
4505no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004506 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004507 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4508 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004509 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004510
4511 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4512 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4513 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4514 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4515 connections.
4516
4517 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4518 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4519 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4520 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4521 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4522 this too.
4523
4524 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4525 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4526 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4527
4528 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4529 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4530 for servers.
4531
4532 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4533 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4534
4535
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004536option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4537 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4539 yes | yes | yes | yes
4540 Arguments :
4541 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4542 matching <network>
4543 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4544 header name.
4545
4546 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4547 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4548 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4549 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4550 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4551 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4552 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4553 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4554 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4555 possible that the client has already brought one.
4556
4557 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4558 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4559 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4560 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4561 header and requires different one.
4562
4563 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4564 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4565 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4566 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4567 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4568 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4569 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4570
4571 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4572 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4573 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4574 both are defined.
4575
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004576 Examples :
4577 # Original Destination address
4578 frontend www
4579 mode http
4580 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4581
4582 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4583 backend www
4584 mode http
4585 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4586
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004587 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4588 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004589
4590
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004591option persist
4592no option persist
4593 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4594 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4595 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004596 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004597
4598 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4599 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4600 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4601 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4602 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4603 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4604 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4605 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4606 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4607 redirected to another valid server.
4608
4609 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4610 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4611
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004612 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004613
4614
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004615option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4616 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4618 yes | no | yes | yes
4619 Arguments :
4620 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4621 PostgreSQL server.
4622
4623 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4624 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4625 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4626 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4627
4628 See also: "option httpchk"
4629
4630
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004631option prefer-last-server
4632no option prefer-last-server
4633 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4634 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4635 yes | no | yes | yes
4636 Arguments : none
4637
4638 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4639 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4640 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4641 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4642 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4643 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4644 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4645 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4646 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004647 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4648 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4649 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4650 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4651 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4652 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4653 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004654
4655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4657
4658 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4659
4660
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004661option redispatch
4662no option redispatch
4663 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4664 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4665 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004666 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004667
4668 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4669 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4670 be able to access the service anymore.
4671
4672 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4673 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4674
4675 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4676 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4677 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004679 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4680 "redisp" keywords.
4681
4682 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4683 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4684
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004685 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004686
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004687
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004688option redis-check
4689 Use redis health checks for server testing
4690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4691 yes | no | yes | yes
4692 Arguments : none
4693
4694 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4695 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4696 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4697 find the "+PONG" response message.
4698
4699 Example :
4700 option redis-check
4701
4702 See also : "option httpchk"
4703
4704
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004705option smtpchk
4706option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4707 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4709 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004710 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004711 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4712 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4713 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4714
4715 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4716 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4717 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4718
4719 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4720 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4721 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4722 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4723 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4724 dead server.
4725
4726 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4727 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4728 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4729 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4730
4731 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4732 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4733 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4734 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4735 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4736
4737 Example :
4738 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4739
4740 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4741
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004742
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004743option socket-stats
4744no option socket-stats
4745
4746 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4748 yes | yes | yes | no
4749
4750 Arguments : none
4751
4752
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004753option splice-auto
4754no option splice-auto
4755 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4757 yes | yes | yes | yes
4758 Arguments : none
4759
4760 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4761 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4762 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4763 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004764 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004765 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4766 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4767 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4768 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4769
4770 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4771 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4772 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4773 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4774 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4775 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4776 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4777 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4778 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4779 keyword.
4780
4781 Example :
4782 option splice-auto
4783
4784 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4785 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4786
4787 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4788 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4789
4790
4791option splice-request
4792no option splice-request
4793 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4795 yes | yes | yes | yes
4796 Arguments : none
4797
4798 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004799 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004800 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4801 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4802 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4803 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4804
4805 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4806
4807 Example :
4808 option splice-request
4809
4810 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4811 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4812
4813 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4814 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4815
4816
4817option splice-response
4818no option splice-response
4819 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4821 yes | yes | yes | yes
4822 Arguments : none
4823
4824 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004825 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004826 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4827 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4828 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4829 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4830
4831 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4832
4833 Example :
4834 option splice-response
4835
4836 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4837 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4838
4839 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4840 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4841
4842
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004843option srvtcpka
4844no option srvtcpka
4845 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4847 yes | no | yes | yes
4848 Arguments : none
4849
4850 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4851 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4852 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4853 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4854
4855 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4856 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4857 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4858 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4859
4860 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4861 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4862 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4863 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4864 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4865
4866 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4867
4868 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4869 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4870 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4871
4872 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4873 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4874
4875 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4876
4877
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004878option ssl-hello-chk
4879 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4881 yes | no | yes | yes
4882 Arguments : none
4883
4884 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4885 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4886 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4887 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4888 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4889 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4890 hello message.
4891
4892 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4893 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4894 messages, which is appreciable.
4895
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004896 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4897 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4898 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004899
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004900 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4901
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004902
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004903option tcp-check
4904 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4905 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4906 yes | no | yes | yes
4907
4908 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4909 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4910
4911 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4912 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4913 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4914
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004915 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004916 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4917 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4918 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4919 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4920 only.
4921
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004922 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004923 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4924 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4925 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4926 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4927
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004928 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004929 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4930 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004931 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004932 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4933 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4934 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4935 the respective protocols.
4936 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4937 analysed.
4938
4939 Examples :
4940 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4941 option tcp-check
4942 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4943
4944 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4945 option tcp-check
4946 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4947
4948 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4949 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004950 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004951 option tcp-check
4952 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4953 tcp-check expect +PONG
4954 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4955 tcp-check expect string role:master
4956 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4957 tcp-check expect string +OK
4958
4959 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4960 (send many headers before analyzing)
4961 option tcp-check
4962 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4963 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4964 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4965 tcp-check send \r\n
4966 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4967
4968
4969 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4970
4971
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004972option tcp-smart-accept
4973no option tcp-smart-accept
4974 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4976 yes | yes | yes | no
4977 Arguments : none
4978
4979 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4980 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4981 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4982 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4983 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4984 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4985
4986 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4987 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4988 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4989 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4990
4991 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4992 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4993 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4994 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4995
4996 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4997 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4998 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4999
5000 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5001 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5002 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5003
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005004 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5005
5006
5007option tcp-smart-connect
5008no option tcp-smart-connect
5009 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5011 yes | no | yes | yes
5012 Arguments : none
5013
5014 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5015 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5016 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5017 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5018 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5019
5020 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5021 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5022 complex.
5023
5024 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5025 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5026 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5027
5028 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5029 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5030
5031 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5032
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005033
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005034option tcpka
5035 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5037 yes | yes | yes | yes
5038 Arguments : none
5039
5040 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5041 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5042 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5043 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5044
5045 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5046 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5047 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5048 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5049
5050 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5051 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5052 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5053 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5054 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5055
5056 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5057
5058 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5059 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5060 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5061 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5062 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5063 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5064 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5065 backends.
5066
5067 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5068
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005069
5070option tcplog
5071 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5073 yes | yes | yes | yes
5074 Arguments : none
5075
5076 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5077 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5078 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5079 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5080 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5081 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5082 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5083 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5084
5085 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005087 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005088
5089
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005090option transparent
5091no option transparent
5092 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005094 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005095 Arguments : none
5096
5097 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5098 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5099 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5100 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5101 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5102 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5103 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5104 appropriate server.
5105
5106 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5107 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5108
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005109 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005110 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005111
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005112
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005113persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005114persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005115 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5117 yes | no | yes | yes
5118 Arguments :
5119 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005120 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5121 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005122
5123 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5124 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5125 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5126 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5127 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5128 forwarded to this server.
5129
5130 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5131 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5132 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005133 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005134 a single "listen" section.
5135
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005136 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5137 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5138 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5139
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005140 Example :
5141 listen tse-farm
5142 bind :3389
5143 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5144 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5145 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5146 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5147 persist rdp-cookie
5148 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005149 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005150 balance rdp-cookie
5151 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5152 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5153
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005154 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5155 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005156
5157
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005158rate-limit sessions <rate>
5159 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5161 yes | yes | yes | no
5162 Arguments :
5163 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5164 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5165
5166 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5167 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5168 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5169 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5170 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5171 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5172
5173 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5174 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5175 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5176 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5177
5178 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5179 listen smtp
5180 mode tcp
5181 bind :25
5182 rate-limit sessions 10
5183 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5184
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005185 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5186 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5187 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005188
5189 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5190
5191
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005192redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5193redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5194redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005195 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5197 no | yes | yes | yes
5198
5199 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005200 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005201
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005202 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005203 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005204 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5205 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5206 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005207
5208 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5209 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5210 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5211 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5212 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005213 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5214 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5215 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5216 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005217
5218 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5219 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5220 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5221 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5222 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5223 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005224 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005225 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005226 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5227 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5228 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005229
5230 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005231 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5232 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5233 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5234 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5235 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5236 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5237 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5238 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005239
5240 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5241 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5242
5243 - "drop-query"
5244 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5245 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5246 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5247 with a location-type redirect.
5248
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005249 - "append-slash"
5250 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5251 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5252 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5253 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5254
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005255 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5256 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5257 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5258 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5259 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5260 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5261 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5262
5263 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5264 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5265 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5266 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5267 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5268 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5269 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005270
5271 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5272 acl clear dst_port 80
5273 acl secure dst_port 8080
5274 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005275 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005276 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005277 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5278
5279 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005280 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5281 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5282 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005283 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005284
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005285 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5286 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5287 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5288
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005289 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005290 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005291
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005292 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5293 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5294 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005296 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005297
5298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005299redisp (deprecated)
5300redispatch (deprecated)
5301 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5302 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5303 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005304 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005305
5306 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5307 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5308 be able to access the service anymore.
5309
5310 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5311 redistribute them to a working server.
5312
5313 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5314 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5315 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005316
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005317 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5318 "option redispatch" instead.
5319
5320 See also : "option redispatch"
5321
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005322
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005323reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005324 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5326 no | yes | yes | yes
5327 Arguments :
5328 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5329 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005330 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005331
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005332 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5333 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5334
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005335 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5336 the last header of an HTTP request.
5337
5338 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5339 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5340 responses.
5341
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005342 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5343 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5344 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5345
5346 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5347 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005348
5349
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005350reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5351reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005352 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5354 no | yes | yes | yes
5355 Arguments :
5356 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5357 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5358 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5359 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5360 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5361 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5362 ignores case.
5363
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005364 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5365 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5366
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005367 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5368 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5369 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5370 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005371 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005372
5373 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5374 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5375
5376 Example :
5377 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5378 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5379 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5380
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005381 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5382 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005383
5384
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005385reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5386reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005387 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5389 no | yes | yes | yes
5390 Arguments :
5391 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5392 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5393 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5394 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5395 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5396 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5397
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005398 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5399 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5400
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005401 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5402 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5403 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5404 next servers.
5405
5406 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5407 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5408 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5409
5410 Example :
5411 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5412 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5413 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5414
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005415 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5416 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005417
5418
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005419reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5420reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005421 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5423 no | yes | yes | yes
5424 Arguments :
5425 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5426 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5427 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5428 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5429 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5430 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5431 case.
5432
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005433 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5434 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5435
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005436 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5437 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5438 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5439 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005440 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005441
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005442 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005443 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005444 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005445
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005446 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5447 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5448
5449 Example :
5450 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5451 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5452 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5453
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005454 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5455 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005456
5457
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005458reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5459reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005460 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5462 no | yes | yes | yes
5463 Arguments :
5464 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5465 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5466 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5467 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5468 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5469 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5470 case.
5471
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005472 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5473 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5474
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005475 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5476 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5477 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5478 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5479
5480 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5481 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5482
5483 Example :
5484 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5485 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5486 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5487 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5488
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005489 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5490 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005491
5492
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005493reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5494reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005495 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5497 no | yes | yes | yes
5498 Arguments :
5499 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5500 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5501 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5502 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5503 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5504 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5505
5506 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5507 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5508 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5509 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005510 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005511
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005512 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5513 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5514
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005515 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5516 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5517 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5518
5519 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5520 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5521 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5522 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5523 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5524
5525 Example :
5526 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005527 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005528 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5529 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5530
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005531 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5532 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005533
5534
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005535reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5536reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005537 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5539 no | yes | yes | yes
5540 Arguments :
5541 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5542 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5543 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5544 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5545 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5546 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5547 ignores case.
5548
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005549 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5550 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5551
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005552 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5553 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005554 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5555 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5556 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005557 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5558 not set.
5559
5560 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5561 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5562 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5563 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5564 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5565
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005566 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005567 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5568 # block all others.
5569 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5570 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5571
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005572 # block bad guys
5573 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5574 reqitarpit . if badguys
5575
5576 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5577 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005578
5579
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005580retries <value>
5581 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5582 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5583 yes | no | yes | yes
5584 Arguments :
5585 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5586 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5587 default value is 3.
5588
5589 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5590 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5591 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5592
5593 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5594 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5595
5596 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5597 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5598
5599 See also : "option redispatch"
5600
5601
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005602rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005603 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5605 no | yes | yes | yes
5606 Arguments :
5607 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5608 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005609 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005610
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005611 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5612 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5613
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005614 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5615 the last header of an HTTP response.
5616
5617 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5618 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5619 responses.
5620
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005621 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5622 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005623
5624
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005625rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5626rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005627 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5629 no | yes | yes | yes
5630 Arguments :
5631 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5632 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5633 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5634 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5635 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5636 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5637 ignores case.
5638
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005639 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5640 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5641
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005642 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5643 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005644 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005645 client.
5646
5647 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5648 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5649 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5650
5651 Example :
5652 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005653 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005654
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005655 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5656 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005657
5658
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005659rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5660rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005661 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5663 no | yes | yes | yes
5664 Arguments :
5665 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5666 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5667 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5668 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5669 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5670 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5671 ignores case.
5672
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005673 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5674 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5675
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005676 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5677 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5678 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5679 case-sensitive.
5680
5681 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005682 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5683 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5684 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005685
5686 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5687 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5688
5689 Example :
5690 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5691 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5692
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005693 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5694 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005695
5696
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005697rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5698rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005699 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5701 no | yes | yes | yes
5702 Arguments :
5703 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5704 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5705 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5706 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5707 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5708 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5709 ignores case.
5710
5711 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5712 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5713 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5714 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005715 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005716
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005717 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5718 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5719
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005720 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5721 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5722 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5723
5724 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5725 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5726 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5727 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5728 are not case-sensitive.
5729
5730 Example :
5731 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5732 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5733
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005734 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5735 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005736
5737
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005738server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005739 Declare a server in a backend
5740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5741 no | no | yes | yes
5742 Arguments :
5743 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005744 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005745 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005746
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005747 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5748 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5749 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5750 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005751 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5752 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5753 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5754 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5755 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005756 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5757 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5758 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5759 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5760 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5761 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5762 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005763 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005764 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5765 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5766 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5767 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005768
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005769 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005770 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5771 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5772 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5773 adding this value to the client's port.
5774
5775 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5776 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005777 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005778
5779 Examples :
5780 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5781 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005782 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005783 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5784 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5785 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005786
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005787 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5788 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005789
5790
5791source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005792source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005793source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005794 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5796 yes | no | yes | yes
5797 Arguments :
5798 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5799 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005800
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005801 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005802 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5803 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5804 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5805 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5806 supported prefixes are :
5807 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5808 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5809 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005810 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005811 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5812 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5813 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5814 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005815
5816 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5817 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005818 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5819 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5820 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005821
5822 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5823 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5824 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5825 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5826 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5827 <addr>.
5828
5829 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5830 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5831 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5832 port.
5833
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005834 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5835 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5836 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5837 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005838 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005839 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5840 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5841 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5842 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5843 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5844 HTTP header.
5845
5846 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5847 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005848 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005849 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5850 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5851 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5852 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5853 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5854 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5855 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5856
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005857 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5858 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5859 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5860 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5861 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5862 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5863
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005864 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5865 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5866 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5867 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5868
5869 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5870 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5871 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5872 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5873 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5874 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5875
5876 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5877 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5878 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5879 there are two methods :
5880
5881 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5882 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5883 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5884 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5885 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5886 of the client ranges may be used.
5887
5888 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5889 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5890 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5891 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5892 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5893 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5894 same session.
5895
5896 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5897 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5898 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5899 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5900 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5901 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5902
5903 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5904 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5905 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005906 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005907
5908 Examples :
5909 backend private
5910 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5911 source 192.168.1.200
5912
5913 backend transparent_ssl1
5914 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5915 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5916
5917 backend transparent_ssl2
5918 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5919 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5920 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5921
5922 backend transparent_ssl3
5923 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5924 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5925 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5926
5927 backend transparent_smtp
5928 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5929 # with Tproxy version 4.
5930 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5931
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005932 backend transparent_http
5933 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5934 # proxy.
5935 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5936
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005937 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005938 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5939
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005940
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005941srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5942 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5944 yes | no | yes | yes
5945 Arguments :
5946 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5947 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5948 as explained at the top of this document.
5949
5950 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5951 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5952 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5953 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5954 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5955 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5956 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5957
5958 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5959 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5960 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5961 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5962 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005963 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005964 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005965 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005966
5967 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5968 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5969 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5970 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5971 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5972 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5973
5974 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5975 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5976
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005977 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5978 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005979
5980
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005981stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5982 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02005984 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005985
5986 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5987 matched.
5988
5989 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5990 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5991
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005992 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5993 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5994 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5995
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005996 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5997 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5998 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5999 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006000
6001 Example :
6002 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6003 backend stats_localhost
6004 stats enable
6005 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6006
6007 Example :
6008 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6009 backend stats_auth
6010 stats enable
6011 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6012 stats admin if TRUE
6013
6014 Example :
6015 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6016 userlist stats-auth
6017 group admin users admin
6018 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6019 group readonly users haproxy
6020 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6021
6022 backend stats_auth
6023 stats enable
6024 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6025 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6026 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6027 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6028
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006029 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6030 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6031 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006032
6033
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006034stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6035 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006037 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006038 Arguments :
6039 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6040
6041 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6042
6043 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6044 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6045 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6046 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6047 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6048 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6049
6050 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6051 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6052 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006053 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006054
6055 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6056 report using "stats scope".
6057
6058 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6059 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6060 unobvious parameters.
6061
6062 Example :
6063 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6064 backend public_www
6065 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6066 stats enable
6067 stats hide-version
6068 stats scope .
6069 stats uri /admin?stats
6070 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6071 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6072 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6073
6074 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6075 backend private_monitoring
6076 stats enable
6077 stats uri /admin?stats
6078 stats refresh 5s
6079
6080 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6081
6082
6083stats enable
6084 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006086 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006087 Arguments : none
6088
6089 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6090 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6091 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6092 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6093 - stats auth : no authentication
6094 - stats scope : no restriction
6095
6096 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6097 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6098 unobvious parameters.
6099
6100 Example :
6101 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6102 backend public_www
6103 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6104 stats enable
6105 stats hide-version
6106 stats scope .
6107 stats uri /admin?stats
6108 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6109 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6110 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6111
6112 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6113 backend private_monitoring
6114 stats enable
6115 stats uri /admin?stats
6116 stats refresh 5s
6117
6118 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6119
6120
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006121stats hide-version
6122 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006124 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006125 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006126
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006127 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6128 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6129 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6130 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6131 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6132 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006133
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006134 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6135 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6136 unobvious parameters.
6137
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006138 Example :
6139 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6140 backend public_www
6141 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006142 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006143 stats hide-version
6144 stats scope .
6145 stats uri /admin?stats
6146 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6147 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6148 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006149
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006150 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6151 backend private_monitoring
6152 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006153 stats uri /admin?stats
6154 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006155
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006156 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006157
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006158
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006159stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6160 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6161 Access control for statistics
6162
6163 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6164 no | no | yes | yes
6165
6166 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6167 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6168 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6169 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6170 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6171 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6172
6173 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6174 instance.
6175
6176 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6177 about ACL usage.
6178
6179
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006180stats realm <realm>
6181 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006183 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006184 Arguments :
6185 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6186 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6187 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6188
6189 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6190 using a backslash ('\').
6191
6192 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6193 only related to authentication.
6194
6195 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6196 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6197 unobvious parameters.
6198
6199 Example :
6200 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6201 backend public_www
6202 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6203 stats enable
6204 stats hide-version
6205 stats scope .
6206 stats uri /admin?stats
6207 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6208 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6209 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6210
6211 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6212 backend private_monitoring
6213 stats enable
6214 stats uri /admin?stats
6215 stats refresh 5s
6216
6217 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6218
6219
6220stats refresh <delay>
6221 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006223 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006224 Arguments :
6225 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6226 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6227 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6228 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6229 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6230 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6231
6232 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6233 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6234 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6235 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6236
6237 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6238 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6239 unobvious parameters.
6240
6241 Example :
6242 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6243 backend public_www
6244 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6245 stats enable
6246 stats hide-version
6247 stats scope .
6248 stats uri /admin?stats
6249 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6250 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6251 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6252
6253 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6254 backend private_monitoring
6255 stats enable
6256 stats uri /admin?stats
6257 stats refresh 5s
6258
6259 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6260
6261
6262stats scope { <name> | "." }
6263 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006265 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006266 Arguments :
6267 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6268 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6269 section in which the statement appears.
6270
6271 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6272 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6273 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6274 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6275 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6276 exists.
6277
6278 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6279 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6280 unobvious parameters.
6281
6282 Example :
6283 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6284 backend public_www
6285 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6286 stats enable
6287 stats hide-version
6288 stats scope .
6289 stats uri /admin?stats
6290 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6291 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6292 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6293
6294 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6295 backend private_monitoring
6296 stats enable
6297 stats uri /admin?stats
6298 stats refresh 5s
6299
6300 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6301
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006302
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006303stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006304 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006306 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006307
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006308 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006309 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6310
6311 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6312 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6313
6314 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6315 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006316 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006317
6318 Example :
6319 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6320 backend private_monitoring
6321 stats enable
6322 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6323 stats uri /admin?stats
6324 stats refresh 5s
6325
6326 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6327 global section.
6328
6329
6330stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006331 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6333 yes | yes | yes | yes
6334 Arguments : none
6335
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006336 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006337 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6338 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6339 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6340 - IP (socket, server)
6341 - cookie (backend, server)
6342
6343 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6344 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006345 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006346
6347 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6348
6349
6350stats show-node [ <name> ]
6351 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006353 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006354 Arguments:
6355 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6356 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6357
6358 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6359 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006360 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006361
6362 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6363 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6364 unobvious parameters.
6365
6366 Example:
6367 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6368 backend private_monitoring
6369 stats enable
6370 stats show-node Europe-1
6371 stats uri /admin?stats
6372 stats refresh 5s
6373
6374 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6375 section.
6376
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006377
6378stats uri <prefix>
6379 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006381 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006382 Arguments :
6383 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6384 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6385 query string.
6386
6387 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6388 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6389 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6390 possible to reach it in the application.
6391
6392 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006393 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006394 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6395 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6396 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6397 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6398
6399 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6400 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6401 an address or a port to statistics only.
6402
6403 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6404 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6405 unobvious parameters.
6406
6407 Example :
6408 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6409 backend public_www
6410 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6411 stats enable
6412 stats hide-version
6413 stats scope .
6414 stats uri /admin?stats
6415 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6416 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6417 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6418
6419 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6420 backend private_monitoring
6421 stats enable
6422 stats uri /admin?stats
6423 stats refresh 5s
6424
6425 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6426
6427
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006428stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6429 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006431 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006432
6433 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006434 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006435 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6436 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6437 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6438
6439 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6440 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6441 the "stick-table" statement.
6442
6443 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6444 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6445 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6446 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6447 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6448
6449 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6450 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6451 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6452 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6453 transformation rules.
6454
6455 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6456 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6457 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6458 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6459 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6460 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6461 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6462
6463 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6464 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6465 ACL based conditions.
6466
6467 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6468 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6469 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6470 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6471
6472 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6473 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6474 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6475 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6476
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006477 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6478 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6479 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6480
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006481 Example :
6482 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6483 # last 30 minutes
6484 backend pop
6485 mode tcp
6486 balance roundrobin
6487 stick store-request src
6488 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6489 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6490 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6491
6492 backend smtp
6493 mode tcp
6494 balance roundrobin
6495 stick match src table pop
6496 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6497 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6498
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006499 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6500 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006501
6502
6503stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6504 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6506 no | no | yes | yes
6507
6508 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6509 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6510 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6511 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6512
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006513 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6514 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6515 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6516
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006517 Examples :
6518 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006519 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006520
6521 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6522 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6523 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6524
6525
6526 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6527 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6528 backend http
6529 mode http
6530 balance roundrobin
6531 stick on src table https
6532 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6533 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6534 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6535
6536 backend https
6537 mode tcp
6538 balance roundrobin
6539 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6540 stick on src
6541 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6542 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6543
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006544 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006545
6546
6547stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6548 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6550 no | no | yes | yes
6551
6552 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006553 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006554 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6555 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6556 server is selected.
6557
6558 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6559 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6560 the "stick-table" statement.
6561
6562 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6563 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6564 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6565 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6566 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6567 address.
6568
6569 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6570 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6571 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6572 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6573 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6574 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6575 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6576 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6577 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6578 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6579
6580 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6581 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6582 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6583 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6584 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6585 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6586 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6587
6588 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6589 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6590 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6591 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6592
6593 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6594 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6595 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6596 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6597 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6598 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006599 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6600 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6601 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6602 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6603 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6604 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006605
6606 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6607 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6608 the request.
6609
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006610 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6611 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6612 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6613
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006614 Example :
6615 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6616 # last 30 minutes
6617 backend pop
6618 mode tcp
6619 balance roundrobin
6620 stick store-request src
6621 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6622 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6623 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6624
6625 backend smtp
6626 mode tcp
6627 balance roundrobin
6628 stick match src table pop
6629 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6630 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6631
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006632 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6633 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006634
6635
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006636stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006637 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6638 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006639 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006641 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006642
6643 Arguments :
6644 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6645 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6646 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6647 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6648
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006649 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6650 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6651 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6652 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6653
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006654 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6655 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6656 instance.
6657
6658 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6659 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6660 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6661 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6662 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6663 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006664 to 32 characters.
6665
6666 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6667 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6668 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6669 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6670 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6671 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006672
6673 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006674 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6675 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006676 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6677 increase.
6678
6679 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006680 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6681 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6682 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006683
6684 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6685 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6686 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6687 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6688 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6689 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6690 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6691 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6692 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6693 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6694 parameter (see below).
6695
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006696 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6697 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6698 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6699 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6700 soft restart.
6701
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006702 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6703
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006704 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6705 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6706 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6707 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6708 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006709 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006710 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6711 if not expiration delay is specified.
6712
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006713 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6714 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6715 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6716 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006717 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6718 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6719 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6720 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6721 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6722 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6723 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6724 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6725 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6726 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6727 types and their arguments.
6728
6729 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6730 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6731 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6732 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6733
6734 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6735 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6736 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6737 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6738
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006739 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6740 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6741 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6742 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6743 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6744 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6745
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006746 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6747 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6748 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6749 they were received.
6750
6751 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6752 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6753 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6754 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6755 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6756
6757 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6758 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6759 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6760 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6761 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6762
6763 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6764 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6765 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6766
6767 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6768 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6769 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6770 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6771 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6772
6773 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6774 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6775 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6776 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6777 the client side.
6778
6779 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6780 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6781 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6782 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6783 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6784 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6785 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6786
6787 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6788 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6789 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6790 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6791 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6792 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6793 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6794
6795 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6796 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6797 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6798 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6799 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6800 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6801
6802 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6803 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6804 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6805 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6806
6807 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6808 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6809 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6810 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6811 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6812 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6813 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6814 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6815 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6816 recommended for better fairness.
6817
6818 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6819 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6820 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6821 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6822
6823 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6824 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6825 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6826 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6827 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6828 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6829 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6830 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6831 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6832 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006833
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006834 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6835 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006836 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6837 reference it.
6838
6839 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6840 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6841 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6842 as an exclusive stickiness.
6843
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006844 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6845 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6846 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6847 something that can be ignored.
6848
6849 Example:
6850 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6851 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6852 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6853 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6854
6855 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006856 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006857
6858
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006859stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6860 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6862 no | no | yes | yes
6863
6864 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006865 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006866 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6867 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6868 server is selected.
6869
6870 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6871 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6872 the "stick-table" statement.
6873
6874 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6875 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6876 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6877 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6878
6879 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6880 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6881 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6882 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6883 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6884 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006885 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006886 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6887 rules.
6888
6889 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6890 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6891 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6892 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6893 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6894 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6895 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6896
6897 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6898 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6899 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6900 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6901
6902 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6903 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6904 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6905 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6906 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6907 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006908 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6909 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6910 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6911 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6912 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6913 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6914 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6915 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6916 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006917
6918 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6919
6920 Example :
6921 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6922 backend https
6923 mode tcp
6924 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006925 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006926 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006927
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006928 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6929 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6930
6931 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6932 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6933 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6934
6935 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6936 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006937
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006938 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6939 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6940 # at offset 44.
6941
6942 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6943 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6944
6945 # Learn on response if server hello.
6946 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006947
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006948 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6949 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6950
6951 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6952 extraction.
6953
6954
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02006955tcp-check connect [params*]
6956 Opens a new connection
6957 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6958 no | no | yes | yes
6959
6960 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
6961 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
6962 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
6963
6964 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6965 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
6966 of the sequence.
6967
6968 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6969 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6970 do.
6971
6972 Parameters :
6973 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
6974 use the TCP connection.
6975
6976 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
6977 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6978 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
6979
6980 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6981
6982 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6983
6984 Examples:
6985 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6986 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6987 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6988 option tcp-check
6989 tcp-check connect
6990 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
6991 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
6992 tcp-check send \r\n
6993 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
6994 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
6995 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
6996 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
6997 tcp-check send \r\n
6998 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
6999 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7000
7001 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7002 option tcp-check
7003 tcp-check connect port 110
7004 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7005 tcp-check connect port 143
7006 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7007 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7008
7009 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7010
7011
7012tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7013 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7014 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7015 no | no | yes | yes
7016
7017 Arguments :
7018 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7019 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7020 binary.
7021 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7022 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7023 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7024
7025 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7026 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7027 with the usual backslash ('\').
7028 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7029 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7030 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7031 used upper or lower case.
7032
7033
7034 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7035
7036 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7037 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7038 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7039 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7040 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7041 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7042 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7043 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7044
7045 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7046 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7047 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7048 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7049 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7050 expression.
7051
7052 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7053 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7054 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7055 this exact hexadecimal string.
7056 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7057
7058 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7059 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7060 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7061 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7062 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7063 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7064 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7065 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7066 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7067 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7068 the null character.
7069
7070 Examples :
7071 # perform a POP check
7072 option tcp-check
7073 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7074
7075 # perform an IMAP check
7076 option tcp-check
7077 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7078
7079 # look for the redis master server
7080 option tcp-check
7081 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7082 tcp-check expect +PONG
7083 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7084 tcp-check expect string role:master
7085 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7086 tcp-check expect string +OK
7087
7088
7089 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7090 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7091
7092
7093tcp-check send <data>
7094 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7095 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7096 no | no | yes | yes
7097
7098 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7099 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7100
7101 Examples :
7102 # look for the redis master server
7103 option tcp-check
7104 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7105 tcp-check expect string role:master
7106
7107 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7108 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7109
7110
7111tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7112 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7113 tcp health check
7114 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7115 no | no | yes | yes
7116
7117 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7118 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7119 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7120 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7121 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7122 hexadecimal string.
7123 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7124
7125 Examples :
7126 # redis check in binary
7127 option tcp-check
7128 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7129 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7130
7131
7132 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7133 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7134
7135
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007136tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7137 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7139 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007140 Arguments :
7141 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007142 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7143 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007144
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007145 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007146
7147 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7148 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007149 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7150 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7151 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7152 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7153 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7154 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007155
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007156 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7157 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7158 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7159 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007160
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007161 Three types of actions are supported :
7162 - accept :
7163 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7164 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7165 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007166
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007167 - reject :
7168 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7169 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7170 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7171 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7172 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7173 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7174 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7175 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7176 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7177 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7178 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7179 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007180
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007181 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7182 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7183 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7184 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7185 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7186 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7187 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7188 hosts.
7189
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007190 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007191 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7192 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7193 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007194 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7195 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007196 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007197 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7198 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7199 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7200 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7201 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007202
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007203 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007204 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007205 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007206 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7207 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7208 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7209 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007210
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007211 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7212 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7213 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7214 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007215
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007216 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7217 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7218 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7219 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7220 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007221 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7222 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7223 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7224 layer7 information is extracted.
7225
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007226 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7227 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7228 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7229 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7230 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007231
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007232 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7233 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7234 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007235
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007236 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7237 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7238 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007239
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007240 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007241 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007242 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007243
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007244 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7245 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7246 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007247
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007248 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007249 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7250 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007251
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007252 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7253
7254 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7255
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007256 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7257
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007258 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007259
7260
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007261tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7262 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007264 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007265 Arguments :
7266 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007267 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7268 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02007269 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007270
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007271 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007272
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007273 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7274 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7275 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7276 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7277 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007279 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7280 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7281 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7282 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007283 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7284 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7285 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7286 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7287 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7288 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007289 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007290 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007291
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007292 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7293 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7294 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7295 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007296
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007297 Three types of actions are supported :
7298 - accept :
7299 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007300 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007301
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007302 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7303 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007304
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007305 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7306 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7307 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7308 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7309 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7310 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007312 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007313 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7314 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007315
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007316 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007317 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7318 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7319 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7320 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007321 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7322 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7323 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007324
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007325 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7326 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7327 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7328 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7329
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007330 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007331 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7332 # and reject everything else.
7333 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7334 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007335 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007336 tcp-request content reject
7337
7338 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007339 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7340 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7341 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007342 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007343
7344 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7345 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7346 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007347 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007348 tcp-request content reject
7349
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007350 Example:
7351 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7352 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007353 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007354
7355 Example:
7356 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7357 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007358 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007359
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007360 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7361 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7362
7363 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007364 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007365 # protecting all our sites
7366 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007367 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7368 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007369 ...
7370 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7371
7372 backend http_dynamic
7373 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007374 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007375 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007376 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7377 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7378 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007379 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007381 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007382
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007383 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007384
7385
7386tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7387 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007389 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007390 Arguments :
7391 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7392 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7393 as explained at the top of this document.
7394
7395 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7396 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7397 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7398 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7399 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7400
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007401 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7402 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7403 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7404 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7405
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007406 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7407 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007408 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007409 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007410 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7411 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7412 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7413 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007414
7415 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7416 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7417 it pass through unaffected.
7418
7419 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7420 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7421 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007422 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007423 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7424 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007425 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7426 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7427 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007428
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007429 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007430 "timeout client".
7431
7432
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007433tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7434 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7436 no | no | yes | yes
7437 Arguments :
7438 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007439 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007440
7441 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7442
7443 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7444 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7445 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007446 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7447 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007448
7449 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7450
7451 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7452 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7453 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7454 inserted.
7455
7456 Two types of actions are supported :
7457 - accept :
7458 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7459 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7460 the rules evaluation.
7461
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007462 - close :
7463 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7464 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7465 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7466 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7467 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7468 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007469 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007470 protocols.
7471
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007472 - reject :
7473 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7474 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007475 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007476
7477 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7478 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7479 for changing the default action to a reject.
7480
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007481 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7482 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7483 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7484 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007485 period.
7486
7487 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7488
7489 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7490
7491
7492tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7493 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7495 no | no | yes | yes
7496 Arguments :
7497 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7498 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7499 as explained at the top of this document.
7500
7501 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7502
7503
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007504timeout check <timeout>
7505 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7506 established.
7507
7508 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7509 yes | no | yes | yes
7510 Arguments:
7511 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7512 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7513 as explained at the top of this document.
7514
7515 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7516 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7517 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7518 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007519 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7520 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7521 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007522
7523 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7524 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7525
7526 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7527 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007528 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007529
7530 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7531 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7532 forget about it.
7533
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007534 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7535 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007536
7537
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007538timeout client <timeout>
7539timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7540 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7542 yes | yes | yes | no
7543 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007544 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007545 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7546 as explained at the top of this document.
7547
7548 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7549 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7550 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7551 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7552 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7553 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7554 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7555 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007556 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007557 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007558 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7559 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007560 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7561 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007562
7563 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7564 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7565 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7566 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7567 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7568 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7569
7570 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7571 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7572 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7573
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007574 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007575
7576
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007577timeout client-fin <timeout>
7578 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7580 yes | yes | yes | no
7581 Arguments :
7582 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7583 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7584 as explained at the top of this document.
7585
7586 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7587 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7588 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7589 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7590 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7591 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7592 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7593 down in one direction.
7594
7595 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7596 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7597 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7598
7599 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7600
7601
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007602timeout connect <timeout>
7603timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7604 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7606 yes | no | yes | yes
7607 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007608 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007609 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7610 as explained at the top of this document.
7611
7612 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007613 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007614 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007615 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007616 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7617 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007618
7619 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7620 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7621 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7622 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7623 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7624 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7625
7626 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7627 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7628 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7629
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007630 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7631 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007632
7633
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007634timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7635 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7637 yes | yes | yes | yes
7638 Arguments :
7639 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7640 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7641 as explained at the top of this document.
7642
7643 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7644 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7645 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7646 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7647 once the request has started to present itself.
7648
7649 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7650 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7651 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7652 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7653 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7654
7655 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7656 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7657 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7658 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7659
7660 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7661 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7662 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7663 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7664 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007665 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007666
7667 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7668 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7669 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7670 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7671
7672 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7673
7674
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007675timeout http-request <timeout>
7676 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007678 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007679 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007680 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007681 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7682 as explained at the top of this document.
7683
7684 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7685 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7686 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7687 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7688 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7689 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7690 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7691 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7692
7693 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7694 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007695 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7696 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007697
7698 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7699 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7700 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7701 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7702 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7703
7704 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007705 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7706 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7707 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007708
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007709 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007710
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007711
7712timeout queue <timeout>
7713 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7715 yes | no | yes | yes
7716 Arguments :
7717 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7718 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7719 as explained at the top of this document.
7720
7721 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7722 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7723 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7724 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7725 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7726
7727 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7728 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7729 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7730 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7731
7732 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7733
7734
7735timeout server <timeout>
7736timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7737 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7739 yes | no | yes | yes
7740 Arguments :
7741 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7742 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7743 as explained at the top of this document.
7744
7745 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7746 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7747 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7748 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7749 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7750 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7751 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7752
7753 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7754 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7755 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7756 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7757 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007758 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007759 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007760 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7761 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7762 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7763 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007764
7765 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7766 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7767 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7768 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7769 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7770 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7771
7772 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7773 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7774 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7775
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007776 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007777
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007778
7779timeout server-fin <timeout>
7780 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
7781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7782 yes | no | yes | yes
7783 Arguments :
7784 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7785 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7786 as explained at the top of this document.
7787
7788 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7789 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7790 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7791 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7792 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
7793 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7794 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7795 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
7796 situations, it should not be needed.
7797
7798 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7799 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7800 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
7801
7802 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
7803
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007804
7805timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007806 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7808 yes | yes | yes | yes
7809 Arguments :
7810 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7811 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7812 as explained at the top of this document.
7813
7814 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7815 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7816 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7817
7818 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7819 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7820 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7821 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007822 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007823
7824 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7825
7826
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007827timeout tunnel <timeout>
7828 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7830 yes | no | yes | yes
7831 Arguments :
7832 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7833 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7834 as explained at the top of this document.
7835
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007836 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007837 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7838 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7839 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7840 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7841 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7842 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7843 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7844 specified.
7845
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007846 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
7847 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
7848 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
7849 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
7850 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
7851 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
7852 state.
7853
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007854 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7855 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7856 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7857 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7858 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7859
7860 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7861 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7862 forget about it.
7863
7864 Example :
7865 defaults http
7866 option http-server-close
7867 timeout connect 5s
7868 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007869 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007870 timeout server 30s
7871 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7872
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007873 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007874
7875
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007876transparent (deprecated)
7877 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007879 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007880 Arguments : none
7881
7882 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7883 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7884 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7885 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7886 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7887 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7888 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7889 appropriate server.
7890
7891 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7892
7893 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7894 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7895
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007896 See also: "option transparent"
7897
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007898unique-id-format <string>
7899 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7901 yes | yes | yes | no
7902 Arguments :
7903 <string> is a log-format string.
7904
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007905 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7906 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7907 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7908 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007909
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007910 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7911 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7912 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7913 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7914 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7915 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7916 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7917 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007918
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007919 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7920 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007921
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007922 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007923
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007924 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007925
7926 will generate:
7927
7928 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7929
7930 See also: "unique-id-header"
7931
7932unique-id-header <name>
7933 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7935 yes | yes | yes | no
7936 Arguments :
7937 <name> is the name of the header.
7938
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007939 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7940 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007941
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007942 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007943
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007944 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007945 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7946
7947 will generate:
7948
7949 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7950
7951 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007952
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007953use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007954 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7956 no | yes | yes | no
7957 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007958 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
7959 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007960
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007961 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
7962 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007963
7964 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7965 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7966 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007967 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7968 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7969 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7970 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007971
7972 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7973 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7974 assign the backend.
7975
7976 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7977 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7978 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7979 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7980 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7981 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7982
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007983 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007984 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007985 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7986 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7987 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7988
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007989 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
7990 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
7991 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
7992 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
7993 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
7994 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
7995 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
7996 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
7997 cannot be forced from the request.
7998
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007999 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008000 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8001 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8002
8003 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8004 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008005
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008006
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008007use-server <server> if <condition>
8008use-server <server> unless <condition>
8009 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8011 no | no | yes | yes
8012 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008013 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008014
8015 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8016
8017 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8018 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8019 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8020
8021 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8022 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8023 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8024 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8025 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8026 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8027 matches will assign the server.
8028
8029 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8030 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8031 with the next rules until one matches.
8032
8033 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8034 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8035 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8036 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8037
8038 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8039 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8040 stripped.
8041
8042 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8043 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8044 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8045 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8046
8047 Example :
8048 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8049 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8050 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8051 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8052 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8053 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8054 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8055 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8056 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8057
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008058 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008059
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008060
80615. Bind and Server options
8062--------------------------
8063
8064The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8065depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8066settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8067written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8068described in this section.
8069
8070
80715.1. Bind options
8072-----------------
8073
8074The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8075as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8076no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8077parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8078while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8079provided immediately after the setting name.
8080
8081The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8082
8083accept-proxy
8084 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
8085 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
8086 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8087 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8088 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8089 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8090 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8091 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8092 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008093 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8094 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008095
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008096alpn <protocols>
8097 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8098 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8099 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8100 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8101 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8102 initial NPN extension.
8103
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008104backlog <backlog>
8105 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8106 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8107
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008108ecdhe <named curve>
8109 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008110 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8111 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008112
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008113ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008114 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8115 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8116 client's certificate.
8117
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008118ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8119 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8120 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8121 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8122 error is ignored.
8123
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008124ciphers <ciphers>
8125 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8126 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008127 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008128 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8129 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8130
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008131crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008132 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8133 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8134 to verify client's certificate.
8135
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008136crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008137 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8138 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8139 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8140 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8141 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8142 file.
8143
8144 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8145 are loaded.
8146
8147 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
8148 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
8149 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8150 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8151 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8152 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8153 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8154 www.sub.example.org).
8155
8156 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8157 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8158 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8159 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8160 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8161
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008162 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008163
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008164 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8165 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008166 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008167 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8168 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8169 clients).
8170
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008171crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008172 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8173 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008174 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008175 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008176
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008177crt-list <file>
8178 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008179 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8180 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008181
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008182 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008183
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008184 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8185 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8186 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8187 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8188 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8189 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8190 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8191 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008192
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008193defer-accept
8194 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8195 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8196 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8197 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8198 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8199 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8200 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8201 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8202 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8203 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8204 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8205
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008206force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008207 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008208 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
8209 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8210
8211force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008212 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008213 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8214
8215force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008216 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008217 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8218
8219force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008220 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008221 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8222
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008223gid <gid>
8224 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8225 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8226 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8227 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8228 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8229
8230group <group>
8231 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8232 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8233 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8234 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8235 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8236
8237id <id>
8238 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8239 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8240 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8241 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8242
8243interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008244 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8245 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8246 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8247 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8248 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8249 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8250 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008251
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008252level <level>
8253 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8254 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8255 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8256 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8257 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8258 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8259 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8260 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8261 counters).
8262 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8263 all counters).
8264
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008265maxconn <maxconn>
8266 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8267 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8268 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8269 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8270 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8271 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8272 eat all memory.
8273
8274mode <mode>
8275 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8276 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8277 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8278 UNIX sockets.
8279
8280mss <maxseg>
8281 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8282 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8283 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8284 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8285 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8286 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8287 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8288 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8289 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8290 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8291 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8292
8293name <name>
8294 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8295 page.
8296
8297nice <nice>
8298 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8299 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8300 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8301 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8302 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8303 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8304 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8305 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8306 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8307 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8308 one for an RDP socket.
8309
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008310no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008311 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008312 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008313 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008314 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8315 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008316
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008317no-tls-tickets
8318 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8319 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8320 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8321 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8322
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008323no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008324 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008325 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008326 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8327 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8328 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008329
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008330no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008331 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008332 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008333 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8334 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8335 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008336
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008337no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008338 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008339 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008340 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8341 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8342 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008343
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008344npn <protocols>
8345 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8346 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8347 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8348 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008349 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8350 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008351
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008352process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8353 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8354 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8355 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8356 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8357 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8358 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8359 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008360 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8361 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8362 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8363 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8364 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8365 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8366 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008367
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008368ssl
8369 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008370 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008371 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8372 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8373 to deciphered contents.
8374
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008375strict-sni
8376 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8377 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8378 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8379 See the "crt" option for more information.
8380
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008381tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008382 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008383 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8384 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8385 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8386 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8387 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8388 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8389 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008390 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8391 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8392 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008393
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008394transparent
8395 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8396 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8397 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8398 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8399 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8400 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8401 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8402 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8403 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8404 so check for support with your vendor.
8405
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008406v4v6
8407 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8408 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8409 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8410 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008411 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008412
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008413v6only
8414 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8415 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8416 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008417 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8418 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008419
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008420uid <uid>
8421 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8422 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8423 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8424 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8425 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8426
8427user <user>
8428 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8429 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8430 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8431 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8432 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8433
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008434verify [none|optional|required]
8435 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8436 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8437 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8438 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8439 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008440 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8441 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8442 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8443 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008444
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020084455.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008446------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008448The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8449which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8450arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8451settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8452after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8453Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8454address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008455
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008456 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008457 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008458
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008459The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008460
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008461addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008462 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8463 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8464 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8465 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8466 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008467
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008468 Supported in default-server: No
8469
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008470agent-check
8471 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
8472 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
8473 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
8474 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
8475
8476 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
8477 e.g. "75%"
8478
8479 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8480 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8481
8482 * The string "drain".
8483
8484 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
8485 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
8486 persistence.
8487
8488 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
8489
8490 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
8491
8492 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
8493
8494 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8495
8496 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
8497
8498 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8499
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008500 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8501 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
8502 parameter.
8503
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008504 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
8505 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
8506
8507 Supported in default-server: No
8508
8509agent-inter <delay>
8510 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8511 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8512
8513 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8514 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8515 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8516 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8517 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8518 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8519 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8520 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8521 of backends use the same servers.
8522
8523 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8524
8525 Supported in default-server: Yes
8526
8527agent-port <port>
8528 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8529
8530 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8531
8532 Supported in default-server: Yes
8533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008534backup
8535 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8536 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8537 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8538 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8539 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8540 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008541
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008542 Supported in default-server: No
8543
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008544ca-file <cafile>
8545 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8546 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8547 server's certificate.
8548
8549 Supported in default-server: No
8550
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008551check
8552 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008553 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8554 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8555 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8556 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8557 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8558 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8559 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008560 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8561 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8562 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008563
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008564 Supported in default-server: No
8565
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008566check-send-proxy
8567 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8568 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8569 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8570 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8571 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8572 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8573 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8574
8575 Supported in default-server: No
8576
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008577check-ssl
8578 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8579 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8580 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8581 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008582 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008583 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8584 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8585 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8586 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8587
8588 Supported in default-server: No
8589
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008590ciphers <ciphers>
8591 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008592 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008593 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8594 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8595 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8596 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8597 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8598 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8599
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008600 Supported in default-server: No
8601
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008602cookie <value>
8603 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8604 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8605 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8606 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8607 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8608 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8609 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008611 Supported in default-server: No
8612
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008613crl-file <crlfile>
8614 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8615 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8616 to verify server's certificate.
8617
8618 Supported in default-server: No
8619
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008620crt <cert>
8621 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8622 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8623 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8624 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8625 certificate request.
8626
8627 Supported in default-server: No
8628
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008629disabled
8630 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8631 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8632 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8633 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8634 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8635
8636 Supported in default-server: No
8637
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008638error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008639 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8640 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8641 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008642
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008643 Supported in default-server: Yes
8644
8645 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008646
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008647fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008648 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8649 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8650 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8651
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008652 Supported in default-server: Yes
8653
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008654force-sslv3
8655 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8656 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8657 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8658
8659 Supported in default-server: No
8660
8661force-tlsv10
8662 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8663 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8664
8665 Supported in default-server: No
8666
8667force-tlsv11
8668 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8669 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8670
8671 Supported in default-server: No
8672
8673force-tlsv12
8674 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8675 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8676
8677 Supported in default-server: No
8678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008679id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008680 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8681 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8682 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008683
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008684 Supported in default-server: No
8685
8686inter <delay>
8687fastinter <delay>
8688downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008689 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8690 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8691 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8692 between checks depending on the server state :
8693
8694 Server state | Interval used
8695 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8696 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8697 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8698 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8699 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8700 or yet unchecked. |
8701 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8702 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8703 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008705 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8706 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8707 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8708 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008709 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8710 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8711 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8712 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8713 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008714
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008715 Supported in default-server: Yes
8716
8717maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008718 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8719 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8720 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8721 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8722 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8723 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8724 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8725 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008727 Supported in default-server: Yes
8728
8729maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008730 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8731 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8732 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8733 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8734 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8735 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8736 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8737
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008738 Supported in default-server: Yes
8739
8740minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008741 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8742 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8743 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8744 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8745 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8746 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008747 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008748 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008749
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008750 Supported in default-server: Yes
8751
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008752no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008753 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8754 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008755 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008756
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008757 Supported in default-server: No
8758
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008759no-tls-tickets
8760 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8761 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8762 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8763 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8764
8765 Supported in default-server: No
8766
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008767no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008768 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008769 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8770 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008771 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8772 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008773
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008774 Supported in default-server: No
8775
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008776no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008777 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008778 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8779 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008780 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8781 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008782
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008783 Supported in default-server: No
8784
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008785no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008786 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008787 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8788 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008789 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8790 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008791
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008792 Supported in default-server: No
8793
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008794non-stick
8795 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8796 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8797 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8798
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008799 Supported in default-server: No
8800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008801observe <mode>
8802 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8803 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8804 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8805 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8806 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8807 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008808 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008809
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008810 Supported in default-server: No
8811
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008812 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8813
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008814on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008815 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8816 Currently, four modes are available:
8817 - fastinter: force fastinter
8818 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8819 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8820 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8821 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8822
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008823 Supported in default-server: Yes
8824
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008825 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8826
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008827on-marked-down <action>
8828 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8829 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008830 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8831 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8832 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8833 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8834 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8835 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8836 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8837 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008838
8839 Actions are disabled by default
8840
8841 Supported in default-server: Yes
8842
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008843on-marked-up <action>
8844 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8845 Currently one action is available:
8846 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8847 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8848 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8849 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8850 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8851 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8852 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8853 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8854
8855 Actions are disabled by default
8856
8857 Supported in default-server: Yes
8858
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008859port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008860 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8861 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8862 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8863 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8864 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8865 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008867 Supported in default-server: Yes
8868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008869redir <prefix>
8870 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8871 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8872 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8873 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8874 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8875 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8876 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8877 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008878 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008879 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8880 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8881 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8882 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8883 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8884
8885 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008887 Supported in default-server: No
8888
8889rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008890 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8891 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8892 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008894 Supported in default-server: Yes
8895
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008896send-proxy
8897 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8898 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8899 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8900 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8901 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8902 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8903 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8904 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8905 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008906 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8907 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8908 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8909 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8910 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008911
8912 Supported in default-server: No
8913
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04008914send-proxy-v2
8915 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
8916 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8917 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8918 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8919 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
8920 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
8921 option of the "bind" keyword.
8922
8923 Supported in default-server: No
8924
8925send-proxy-v2-ssl
8926 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
8927 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8928 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8929 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8930 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
8931 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
8932 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
8933 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
8934
8935 Supported in default-server: No
8936
8937send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
8938 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
8939 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8940 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8941 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8942 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
8943 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
8944 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
8945 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
8946 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
8947
8948 Supported in default-server: No
8949
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008950slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008951 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8952 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8953 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8954 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8955 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8956 parameters :
8957
8958 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8959 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8960
8961 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8962 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8963 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8964 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8965
8966 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8967 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8968 seen as failed.
8969
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008970 Supported in default-server: Yes
8971
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008972source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008973source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008974source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008975 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8976 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8977 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8978 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8979
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008980 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8981 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8982 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8983 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8984 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8985 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8986 server.
8987
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008988 Supported in default-server: No
8989
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008990ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008991 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8992 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8993 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8994 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8995 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8996 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008997 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008998
8999 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009001track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009002 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9003 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9004 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9005 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009006 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9007
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009008 Supported in default-server: No
9009
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009010verify [none|required]
9011 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009012 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9013 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9014 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9015 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009016 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9017 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9018 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009019
9020 Supported in default-server: No
9021
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009022verifyhost <hostname>
9023 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9024 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9025 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9026 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9027 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9028 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9029
9030 Supported in default-server: No
9031
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009032weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009033 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9034 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9035 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009036 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9037 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9038 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9039 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9040 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9041 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009042
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009043 Supported in default-server: Yes
9044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009045
90466. HTTP header manipulation
9047---------------------------
9048
9049In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9050response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9051request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9052which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009053against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009054
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009055If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9056to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9057but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9058HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9059stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9060because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9061a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9062still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009064This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9065in section 4.2 :
9066
9067 - reqadd <string>
9068 - reqallow <search>
9069 - reqiallow <search>
9070 - reqdel <search>
9071 - reqidel <search>
9072 - reqdeny <search>
9073 - reqideny <search>
9074 - reqpass <search>
9075 - reqipass <search>
9076 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9077 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9078 - reqtarpit <search>
9079 - reqitarpit <search>
9080 - rspadd <string>
9081 - rspdel <search>
9082 - rspidel <search>
9083 - rspdeny <search>
9084 - rspideny <search>
9085 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9086 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9087
9088With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9089is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9090parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9091prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9092Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9093
9094 \t for a tab
9095 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9096 \n for a new line (LF)
9097 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9098 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9099 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9100 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9101 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9102
9103The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9104portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9105above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9106regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
91079 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9108is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9109
9110The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9111after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9112
9113Notes related to these keywords :
9114---------------------------------
9115 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9116 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9117 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9118
9119 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9120 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9121 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9122
9123 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9124 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9125 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9126 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9127 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9128
9129 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9130 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9131 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9132 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9133 useless headers before adding new ones.
9134
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009135 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009136 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9137
9138 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9139 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9140 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9141
9142 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9143 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009144 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009145
9146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091477. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9148----------------------------------
9149
9150Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9151client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9152The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9153these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9154but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9155data called patterns.
9156
9157
91587.1. ACL basics
9159---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009160
9161The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9162content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9163from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9164simple :
9165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009166 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009167 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009168 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9169 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009171The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9172adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009173
9174In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009176 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009177
9178This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9179Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9180and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009181an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9182conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9183as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9184are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009185
9186ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9187'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9188which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9189
9190There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9191performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009193The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9194specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9195this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009196methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9197ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009198
9199Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9200 - boolean
9201 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9202 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9203 - string
9204 - data block
9205
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009206Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9207converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9208would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9209The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9210which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9211
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009212Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9213keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9214fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9215which are summarized in the table below :
9216
9217 +---------------------+-----------------+
9218 | Sample or converter | Default |
9219 | output type | matching method |
9220 +---------------------+-----------------+
9221 | boolean | bool |
9222 +---------------------+-----------------+
9223 | integer | int |
9224 +---------------------+-----------------+
9225 | ip | ip |
9226 +---------------------+-----------------+
9227 | string | str |
9228 +---------------------+-----------------+
9229 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9230 +---------------------+-----------------+
9231
9232Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9233matching method, see below.
9234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009235The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9236 - boolean
9237 - integer or integer range
9238 - IP address / network
9239 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9240 - regular expression
9241 - hex block
9242
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009243The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9244
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009245 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9246 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009247 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009248 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009249 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009250 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009251 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009253The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9254read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9255if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9256lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9257will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9258beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9259a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9260lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9261exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9262
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009263The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9264parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9265ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9266a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9267check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9268
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009269The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9270socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9271file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009273Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9274loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9275
9276 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9277
9278In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9279the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9280case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9281as well.
9282
9283The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9284sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9285do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9286methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9287is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9288obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9289followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9290default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9291that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9292string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9293
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009294The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9295By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9296string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9297resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9298server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9299waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9300flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9301function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009303There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9304sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9305be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009306
9307 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9308 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009309 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9310 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9311 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9312 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009313
9314 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9315 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009316 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009317
9318 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009319 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009320
9321 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009322 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009323
9324 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9325 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9326
9327 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9328 binary or string samples.
9329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009330 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9331 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009333 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9334 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9335 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009337 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9338 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009340 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9341 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009343 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9344 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009346 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9347 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009348 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009350 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9351 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9352 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009353
9354For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9355request, it is possible to do :
9356
9357 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9358
9359In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9360buffer, one would use the following acl :
9361
9362 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9363
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009364On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9365possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9366
9367 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009369All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9370criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9371method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9372to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9373criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9374the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009376If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009377the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9378For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009380 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9381 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9382 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9383 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009384
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009385
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009386The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9387types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9388combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9389brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9390default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009392 +-------------------------------------------------+
9393 | Input sample type |
9394 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009395 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009396 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9397 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9398 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009399 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009400 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009401 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009402 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009403 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009404 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009405 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009406 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009407 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009408 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009409 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009410 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009411 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009412 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009413 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009414 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009415 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009416 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009417 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009418 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009419 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009420 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9421 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9422 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009423
9424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094257.1.1. Matching booleans
9426------------------------
9427
9428In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9429Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9430When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9431that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9432
9433Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9434return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9435"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9436
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094387.1.2. Matching integers
9439------------------------
9440
9441Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9442enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9443to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9444
9445Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9446matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9447lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009448
9449For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9450unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9451representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9452
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009453As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9454two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9455instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9456ranges and operators.
9457
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009458For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009459operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9460Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9461of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009462
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009463Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009464
9465 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9466 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9467 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9468 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9469 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9470
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009471For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009472
9473 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9474
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009475This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9476
9477 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9478
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094807.1.3. Matching strings
9481-----------------------
9482
9483String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9484different forms :
9485
9486 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9487 patterns ;
9488
9489 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9490 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9491
9492 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9493 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9494
9495 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9496 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9497
9498 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9499 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9500 matches.
9501
9502 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9503 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9504 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009505
9506String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9507exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9508characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9509string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9510to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009511before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009512
9513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095147.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9515---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009516
9517Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9518they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9519possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9520passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9521the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009522the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9523match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009524
9525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095267.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9527-------------------------------------
9528
9529It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9530not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9531a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9532to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9533digits may be used upper or lower case.
9534
9535Example :
9536 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9537 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9538
9539
95407.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9541---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009542
9543IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9544netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9545within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009546host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009547difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9548at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9549does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9550parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009551
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009552IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9553Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9554trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9555IPv6 patterns.
9556
9557HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9558following situations :
9559 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9560 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9561 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9562 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9563 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9564 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9565 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9566 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9567 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9568 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009570
95717.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9572----------------------------------
9573
9574Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9575combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9576
9577 - AND (implicit)
9578 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9579 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009581A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009583 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009585Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9586indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009588For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9589"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9590requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9591is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9592
9593 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9594 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9595 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9596 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9597
9598To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9599and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9600
9601 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9602 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9603 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9604 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9605
9606 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9607 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9608 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9609 use_backend www if host_www
9610
9611It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9612expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9613be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9614the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9615
9616 The following rule :
9617
9618 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9619 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9620
9621 Can also be written that way :
9622
9623 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9624
9625It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9626to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9627simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9628sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9629good use is the following :
9630
9631 With named ACLs :
9632
9633 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9634 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9635 monitor fail if site_dead
9636
9637 With anonymous ACLs :
9638
9639 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9640
9641See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9642
9643
96447.3. Fetching samples
9645---------------------
9646
9647Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9648against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9649sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9650ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9651of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9652available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9653
9654This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9655Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9656compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9657deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9658
9659The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9660matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9661method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9662indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9663
9664As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9665when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9666mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9667the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9668ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9669
9670Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9671multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9672when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9673incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9674are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9675is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9676all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9677
9678Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9679 - name
9680 - name(arg1)
9681 - name(arg1,arg2)
9682
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009683
96847.3.1. Converters
9685-----------------
9686
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009687Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9688of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9689is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9690was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9691has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9692unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9693
9694These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9695sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9696the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9697support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009699The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009700
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009701base64
9702 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9703 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9704 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9705
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009706lower
9707 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9708 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9709 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009710
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009711upper
9712 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
9713 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9714 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009715
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009716hex
9717 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9718 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9719 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9720 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009721
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009722ipmask(<mask>)
9723 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9724 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9725 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9726 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009727
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009728http_date([<offset>])
9729 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9730 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9731 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9732 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9733 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9734 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009735
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009736language(<value>[,<default>])
9737 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9738 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9739 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9740 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9741 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9742 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9743 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9744 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9745 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9746 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9747 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9748 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009749
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009750 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009751
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009752 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9753 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009754
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009755 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9756 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9757 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9758 use_backend spanish if es
9759 use_backend french if fr
9760 use_backend english if en
9761 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009762
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009763map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9764map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9765map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9766 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9767 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9768 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9769 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9770 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9771 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
9772 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
9773 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009774
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009775 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
9776 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
9777 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009778
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009779 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
9780 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009781
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009782 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
9783 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9784 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
9785 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +02009786 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
9787 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009788 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
9789 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9790 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
9791 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9792 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
9793 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9794 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
9795 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9796 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
9797 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9798 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
9799 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9800 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
9801 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009802
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009803 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
9804 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
9805 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
9806 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9807 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009808
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009809 Example :
9810
9811 # this is a comment and is ignored
9812 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9813 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9814 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9815 | | | `---------- value
9816 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
9817 | `---------------------------- key
9818 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9819
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009820
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020098217.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009822--------------------------------------------
9823
9824A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9825not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9826"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9827The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9828
9829always_false : boolean
9830 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9831 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9832
9833always_true : boolean
9834 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9835 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9836
9837avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009838 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009839 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9840 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9841 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9842 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9843 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9844 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9845 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9846 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9847 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9848 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9849 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9850 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9851 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009853be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009854 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9855 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9856 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9857 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9858 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009860be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9861 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9862 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9863 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9864 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9865 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9866 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009867
9868 Example :
9869 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9870 backend dynamic
9871 mode http
9872 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9873 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009875connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9876 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009877 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009878 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9879 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009880
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009881 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009882 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009883 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9884
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009885 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9886 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009887
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009888 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009889 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009890 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009891 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9892 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009893 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009894 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009895
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009896 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9897 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009898 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009899 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009900
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009901date([<offset>]) : integer
9902 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9903 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9904 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9905 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009906 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9907
9908 Example :
9909
9910 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9911 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009912
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009913env(<name>) : string
9914 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9915 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9916 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9917 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9918 certain way.
9919
9920 Examples :
9921 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9922 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9923
9924 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9925 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009927fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9928 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009929 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9930 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009931 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9932 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9933 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9934 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9935 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009937fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9938 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9939 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9940 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9941 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9942 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9943 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9944 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9945 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009946
9947 Example :
9948 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9949 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9950 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9951 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9952 frontend mail
9953 bind :25
9954 mode tcp
9955 maxconn 100
9956 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9957 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9958 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9959 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009961nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9962 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9963 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9964 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009965 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9966 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9967 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009969queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009970 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9971 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9972 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009973 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9974 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9975 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9976 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9977 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9978
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +01009979rand([<range>]) : integer
9980 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
9981 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
9982 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
9983 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
9984 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
9985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009986srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9987 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9988 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9989 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9990 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9991 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9992 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9993 methods.
9994
9995srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9996 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9997 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9998 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9999 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10000 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10001 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10002 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10003
10004srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10005 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10006 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010007 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010008 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10009 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10010 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10011 overloading servers).
10012
10013 Example :
10014 # Redirect to a separate back
10015 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10016 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10017 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10018
10019table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10020 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10021 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10022
10023table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10024 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10025 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10026 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10027
10028
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200100297.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010030----------------------------------
10031
10032The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10033closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10034methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10035sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10036TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010037the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10038counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10039"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010040argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10041the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10042this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010043
10044be_id : integer
10045 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10046 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10047
10048dst : ip
10049 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10050 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10051 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10052 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10053 RFC 4291.
10054
10055dst_conn : integer
10056 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10057 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10058 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10059 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10060 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10061 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10062 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10063 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010065dst_port : integer
10066 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10067 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10068 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10069 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10070 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10071 an HTTP header.
10072
10073fe_id : integer
10074 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10075 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10076 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10077
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010078sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010079sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10080sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10081sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010082 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10083 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10084 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10085
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010086sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010087sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10088sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10089sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010090 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10091 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10092 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10093
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010094sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010095sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10096sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10097sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010098 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10099 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010100 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10101 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10102 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010103
10104 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10105 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010106 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10107 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10108 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010109 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10110 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10111
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010112sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010113sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10114sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10115sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010116 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10117 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10118
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010119sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010120sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10121sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10122sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010123 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10124 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10125 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10126
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010127sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010128sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10129sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10130sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010131 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10132 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10133 See also src_conn_rate.
10134
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010135sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010136sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10137sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10138sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010139 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010140 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010141
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010142sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010143sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10144sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10145sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010146 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10147 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10148 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010149 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10150 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10151 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010152
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010153sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010154sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10155sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10156sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010157 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10158 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10159 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10160
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010161sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010162sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10163sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10164sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010165 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10166 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10167 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10168 src_http_err_rate.
10169
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010170sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010171sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10172sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10173sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010174 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10175 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10176 src_http_req_cnt.
10177
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010178sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010179sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10180sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10181sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010182 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10183 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10184 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10185 src_http_req_rate.
10186
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010187sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010188sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10189sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10190sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010191 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010192 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10193 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10194 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10195 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010196
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010197 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10198 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010199 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10200
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010201sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010202sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10203sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10204sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010205 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10206 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10207 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10208 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
10209
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010210sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010211sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10212sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10213sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010214 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10215 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10216 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10217 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
10218
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010219sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010220sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10221sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10222sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010223 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10224 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10225 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10226 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010227 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010228 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10229
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010230sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010231sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10232sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10233sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010234 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10235 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10236 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10237 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10238 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010239 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010240
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010241sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010242sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10243sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10244sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010245 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10246 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10247 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10248
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010249sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010250sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10251sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10252sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010253 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10254 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010255 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010256 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10257 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010258 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10259 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10260 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010262so_id : integer
10263 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10264 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10265 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010267src : ip
10268 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10269 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10270 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10271 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10272 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10273 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10274 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010275
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010276 Example:
10277 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10278 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010280src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10281 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10282 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10283 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010284 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010286src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10287 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10288 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010289 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010290 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010292src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10293 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10294 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10295 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10296 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10297 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10298 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010299
10300 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10301 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10302 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10303 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010304 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010305 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10306 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010308src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010309 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010310 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010311 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010312 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010314src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010315 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010316 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10317 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010318 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010320src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10321 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10322 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10323 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010324 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010326src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010327 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010328 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010329 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010330 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010332src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010333 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010334 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010335 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10336 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010337 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10338 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10339 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010341src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10342 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10343 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010344 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010345 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010346 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010348src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10349 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10350 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10351 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10352 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010353 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010355src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10356 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10357 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10358 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010359 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010361src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10362 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10363 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10364 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010365 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010366 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010368src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10369 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10370 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10371 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010372 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010373 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10374 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010375
10376 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010377 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010378 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010380src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10381 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
10382 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10383 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
10384 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010385 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
10386 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010388src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10389 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
10390 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010391 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
10392 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010393 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010395src_port : integer
10396 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10397 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10398 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10399 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010401src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10402 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010403 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10404 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10405 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010406 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010408src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10409 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10410 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10411 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10412 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010413 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010415src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10416 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10417 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10418 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10419 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10420 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10421 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10422 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10423 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010424
10425 Example :
10426 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10427 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10428 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10429 listen ssh
10430 bind :22
10431 mode tcp
10432 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010433 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010434 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010435 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010437srv_id : integer
10438 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10439 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10440 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010441
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010442
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200104437.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010444----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010446The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10447closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10448when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10449usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010450future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010451
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010452ssl_bc : boolean
10453 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10454 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10455 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10456
10457ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10458 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10459 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10460
10461ssl_bc_cipher : string
10462 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10463 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10464
10465ssl_bc_protocol : string
10466 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10467 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10468
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010469ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010470 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010471 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10472 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010473
10474ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10475 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10476 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10477 if session was reused or not.
10478
10479ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10480 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10481 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010483ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10484 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10485 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10486 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10487 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10488 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010490ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10491 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10492 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10493 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10494 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010496ssl_c_err : integer
10497 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10498 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10499 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10500 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10501 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010503ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10504 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10505 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10506 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10507 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10508 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10509 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10510 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10511 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010513ssl_c_key_alg : string
10514 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10515 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10516 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010518ssl_c_notafter : string
10519 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10520 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10521 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010523ssl_c_notbefore : string
10524 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10525 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10526 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010528ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10529 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10530 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10531 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10532 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10533 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10534 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10535 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10536 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010538ssl_c_serial : binary
10539 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10540 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10541 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010543ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10544 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10545 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10546 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010548ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10549 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10550 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10551 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010553ssl_c_used : boolean
10554 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10555 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010557ssl_c_verify : integer
10558 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10559 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10560 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10561 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010563ssl_c_version : integer
10564 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10565 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010567ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10568 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10569 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10570 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10571 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010572 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010573 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10574 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10575 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010577ssl_f_key_alg : string
10578 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10579 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10580 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010582ssl_f_notafter : string
10583 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10584 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10585 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010587ssl_f_notbefore : string
10588 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10589 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10590 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010592ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10593 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10594 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10595 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10596 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10597 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10598 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10599 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10600 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010602ssl_f_serial : binary
10603 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10604 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10605 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010606
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010607ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10608 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10609 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10610 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010612ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10613 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10614 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10615 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010617ssl_f_version : integer
10618 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10619 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10620
10621ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010622 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10623 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10624 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010626 Example :
10627 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10628 listen http-https
10629 bind :80
10630 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10631 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10632
10633ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10634 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10635 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10636
10637ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010638 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010639 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10640 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10641 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10642 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10643 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10644 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10645 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10646 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010648ssl_fc_cipher : string
10649 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10650 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010652ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010653 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10654 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010655 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10656 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10657 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10658 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010660ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10661 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010662 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10663 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10664 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10665 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010667ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010668 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010669 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10670 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10671 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10672 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10673 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10674 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10675 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010677ssl_fc_protocol : string
10678 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10679 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010680
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010681ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010682 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010683 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10684 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010686ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10687 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10688 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10689 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10690 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010692ssl_fc_sni : string
10693 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10694 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10695 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10696 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10697 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10698
10699 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10700 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10701 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010702 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10703 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010705 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010706 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10707 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010709ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10710 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10711 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010712
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010713
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200107147.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010715------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010717Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10718sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10719only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10720For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10721be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10722can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10723sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10724for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10725content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010727payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10728 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10729 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10730 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010732payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10733 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10734 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10735 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010737req.len : integer
10738req_len : integer (deprecated)
10739 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10740 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10741 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10742 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10743 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10744 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10745 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10746 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010748req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10749 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010750 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10751 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10752 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10753 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010755 ACL alternatives :
10756 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010758req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10759 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10760 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10761 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10762 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010764 ACL alternatives :
10765 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010767 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010769req.proto_http : boolean
10770req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10771 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10772 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10773 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10774 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10775 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10776 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10777 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010779 Example:
10780 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10781 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10782 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010783 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010785req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10786rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10787 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10788 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10789 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10790 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10791 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10792 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10793 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010795 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10796 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10797 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10798 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10799 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10800 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010802 ACL derivatives :
10803 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010805 Example :
10806 listen tse-farm
10807 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10808 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10809 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10810 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10811 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10812 persist rdp-cookie
10813 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10814 # This is only useful makes sense if
10815 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10816 stick-table type string size 204800
10817 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10818 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10819 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010821 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10822 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010824req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10825rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10826 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10827 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10828 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10829 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010831 ACL derivatives :
10832 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010834req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10835req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10836 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10837 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10838 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10839 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10840 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10841 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10842 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010844req.ssl_sni : string
10845req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10846 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10847 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10848 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10849 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10850 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10851 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10852 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10853 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10854 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10855 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10856 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10857 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010859 ACL derivatives :
10860 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010862 Examples :
10863 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10864 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10865 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10866 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10867 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010869res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10870rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10871 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10872 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10873 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10874 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10875 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10876 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10877 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010879req.ssl_ver : integer
10880req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10881 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10882 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10883 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10884 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10885 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10886 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10887 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10888 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10889 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010891 ACL derivatives :
10892 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010893
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010894res.len : integer
10895 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10896 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10897 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10898 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10899 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10900 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10901 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10902 content inspection.
10903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010904res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10905 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010906 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10907 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10908 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10909 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010911res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10912 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10913 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10914 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10915 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010917 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010919wait_end : boolean
10920 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10921 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10922 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10923 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10924 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10925 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10926 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10927 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010929 Examples :
10930 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10931 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10932 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010934 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10935 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10936 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10937 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10938 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10939 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10940 tcp-request content reject
10941
10942
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109437.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010944--------------------------------------
10945
10946It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10947This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10948data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10949its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10950HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10951content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10952to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10953more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10954response are indexed.
10955
10956base : string
10957 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10958 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10959 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10960 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10961 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10962 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10963 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10964 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10965
10966 ACL derivatives :
10967 base : exact string match
10968 base_beg : prefix match
10969 base_dir : subdir match
10970 base_dom : domain match
10971 base_end : suffix match
10972 base_len : length match
10973 base_reg : regex match
10974 base_sub : substring match
10975
10976base32 : integer
10977 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10978 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10979 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10980 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10981
10982base32+src : binary
10983 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10984 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10985 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10986 per-URL counters.
10987
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010010988capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
10989 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
10990 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10991 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
10992
10993capture.req.method : string
10994 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
10995 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
10996 because it's allocated.
10997
10998capture.req.uri : string
10999 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11000 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11001 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11002 allocated.
11003
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011004capture.req.ver : string
11005 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11006 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11007 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11008
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011009capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11010 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11011 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11012 The first entry is an index of 0.
11013 See also: "capture response header"
11014
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011015capture.res.ver : string
11016 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11017 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11018 persistent flag.
11019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011020req.cook([<name>]) : string
11021cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11022 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11023 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11024 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11025 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11026 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11027 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11028 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11029 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11030
11031 ACL derivatives :
11032 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11033 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11034 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11035 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11036 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11037 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11038 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11039 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011041req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11042cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11043 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11044 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011046req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11047cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11048 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11049 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11050 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11051 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011053cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11054 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11055 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11056 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11057 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11058 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11059 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11060 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11061 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11062 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11063 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011065hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11066 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11067 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11068 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11069 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011070 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011072req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11073 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11074 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11075 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11076 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11077 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11078 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11079 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11080 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011082req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11083 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11084 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11085 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11086 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011088req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11089 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11090 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11091 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11092 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11093 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11094 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11095 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11096 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11097 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11098 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11099 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011101 ACL derivatives :
11102 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11103 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11104 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11105 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11106 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11107 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11108 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11109 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11110
11111req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11112hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11113 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11114 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11115 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11116 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11117 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11118 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11119 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11120 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11121 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11122
11123req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11124hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11125 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11126 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11127 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11128 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11129 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11130 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11131 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11132 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11133
11134req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11135hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11136 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11137 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11138 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11139 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11140 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11141 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11142 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11143
11144http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11145 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11146 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11147 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11148 basic auth is supported.
11149
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011150http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11151 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11152 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11153 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11154 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011155 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11156 basic auth is supported.
11157
11158 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011159 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11160 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11161 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11162 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011163
11164http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011165 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11166 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011167 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11168 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011170method : integer + string
11171 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11172 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11173 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11174 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11175 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11176 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11177 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011179 ACL derivatives :
11180 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011182 Example :
11183 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11184 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11185 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011187path : string
11188 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11189 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11190 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11191 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11192 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11193 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11194 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011196 ACL derivatives :
11197 path : exact string match
11198 path_beg : prefix match
11199 path_dir : subdir match
11200 path_dom : domain match
11201 path_end : suffix match
11202 path_len : length match
11203 path_reg : regex match
11204 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011206req.ver : string
11207req_ver : string (deprecated)
11208 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11209 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11210 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011212 ACL derivatives :
11213 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011215res.comp : boolean
11216 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11217 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11218 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011220res.comp_algo : string
11221 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11222 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11223 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011225res.cook([<name>]) : string
11226scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11227 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11228 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11229 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011231 ACL derivatives :
11232 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011234res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11235scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11236 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11237 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11238 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011240res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11241scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11242 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11243 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11244 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011246res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11247 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11248 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11249 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11250 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11251 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11252 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11253 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11254 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11255 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011257res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11258 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11259 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11260 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11261 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11262 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011264res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11265shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11266 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11267 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11268 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11269 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11270 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11271 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11272 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11273 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011275 ACL derivatives :
11276 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11277 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11278 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11279 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11280 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11281 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11282 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11283 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11284
11285res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11286shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11287 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11288 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11289 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11290 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11291 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011293res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11294shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11295 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11296 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11297 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11298 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11299 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11300 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011302res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11303shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11304 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11305 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11306 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11307 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11308 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11309 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011311res.ver : string
11312resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11313 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11314 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011316 ACL derivatives :
11317 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011319set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11320 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11321 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11322 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11323 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011325 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11326 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011328 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011330status : integer
11331 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11332 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11333 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011335url : string
11336 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11337 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11338 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11339 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11340 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11341 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11342 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011344 ACL derivatives :
11345 url : exact string match
11346 url_beg : prefix match
11347 url_dir : subdir match
11348 url_dom : domain match
11349 url_end : suffix match
11350 url_len : length match
11351 url_reg : regex match
11352 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011354url_ip : ip
11355 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11356 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11357 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11358 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11359 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11360 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11361 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011363url_port : integer
11364 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11365 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11366 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11367 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011369urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11370url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11371 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11372 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11373 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11374 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11375 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11376 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11377 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11378 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11379 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011381 ACL derivatives :
11382 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11383 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11384 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11385 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11386 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11387 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11388 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11389 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011390
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011392 Example :
11393 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11394 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11395 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11396 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011398urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11399 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11400 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11401 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011402
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200114047.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011405---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011406
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011407Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11408every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011409order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011410
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011411ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11412---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011413FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011414HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011415HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11416HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011417HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11418HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11419HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11420HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11421LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011422METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11423METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11424METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11425METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11426METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11427METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011428RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011429REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011430TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011431WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11432---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011433
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011434
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114358. Logging
11436----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011437
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011438One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11439provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11440very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11441provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11442state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011443to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011444headers.
11445
11446In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11447about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11448send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11449
11450 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11451 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11452 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11453 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11454 at the termination.
11455
11456The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11457allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11458as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11459while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11460real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11461delay.
11462
11463
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114648.1. Log levels
11465---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011466
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011467TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011468source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011469HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11470in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11471track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11472syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11473about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011474
11475
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114768.2. Log formats
11477----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011478
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011479HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011480and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11481slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11482options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011483
11484 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11485 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11486 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11487 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11488 extents.
11489
11490 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11491 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11492 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11493 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11494 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11495
11496 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11497 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11498 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11499 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11500 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11501
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011502 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11503 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11504 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11505 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11506
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011507 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11508
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011509Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11510specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11511field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11512servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11513always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11514identifier.
11515
11516Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11517 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11518 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11519 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11520 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11521
11522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115238.2.1. Default log format
11524-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011525
11526This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11527as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11528format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11529
11530 Example :
11531 listen www
11532 mode http
11533 log global
11534 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11535
11536 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11537 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11538 (www/HTTP)
11539
11540 Field Format Extract from the example above
11541 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11542 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11543 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11544 4 'to' to
11545 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11546 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11547
11548Detailed fields description :
11549 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11550 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11551 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11552 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11553 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11554 and processed the connection.
11555 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11556
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011557In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11558"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11559connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11560
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011561It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11562will eventually disappear.
11563
11564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115658.2.2. TCP log format
11566---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011567
11568The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11569is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11570information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11571counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11572emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11573environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11574the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11575sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011576specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11577not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11578fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11579marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011580
11581 Example :
11582 frontend fnt
11583 mode tcp
11584 option tcplog
11585 log global
11586 default_backend bck
11587
11588 backend bck
11589 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11590
11591 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11592 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11593 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11594
11595 Field Format Extract from the example above
11596 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11597 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11598 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11599 4 frontend_name fnt
11600 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11601 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11602 7 bytes_read* 212
11603 8 termination_state --
11604 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11605 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11606
11607Detailed fields description :
11608 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011609 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11610 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11611 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11612 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11613 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011614
11615 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011616 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11617 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11618 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011619
11620 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11621 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11622 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11623 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11624
11625 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11626 and processed the connection.
11627
11628 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11629 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11630 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11631 applications.
11632
11633 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11634 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11635 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11636 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11637 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11638
11639 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11640 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11641 See "Timers" below for more details.
11642
11643 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11644 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11645 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11646 "Timers" below for more details.
11647
11648 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011649 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011650 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11651 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11652 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11653 details.
11654
11655 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11656 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11657 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11658 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11659 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11660
11661 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11662 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11663 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11664 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11665 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11666 for more details.
11667
11668 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011669 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011670 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11671 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11672 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011673 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011674
11675 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11676 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11677 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11678 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11679 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11680 caused by a denial of service attack.
11681
11682 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11683 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11684 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11685 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11686 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11687 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11688 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11689 denial of service attack.
11690
11691 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11692 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11693 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11694 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11695 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11696 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11697 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11698 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11699 be processed than on other servers.
11700
11701 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11702 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11703 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11704 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11705 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11706 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11707 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11708 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11709 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11710 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11711 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11712 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11713 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11714
11715 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11716 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11717 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11718 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11719 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11720 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11721 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11722 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11723
11724 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11725 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11726 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11727 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11728 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11729 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11730 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11731 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11732 occurs.
11733
11734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117358.2.3. HTTP log format
11736----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011737
11738The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11739is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11740the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11741are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11742emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11743generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11744"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11745which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011746frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11747is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011748
11749Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11750slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11751with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11752
11753 Example :
11754 frontend http-in
11755 mode http
11756 option httplog
11757 log global
11758 default_backend bck
11759
11760 backend static
11761 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11762
11763 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11764 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11765 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011766 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011767
11768 Field Format Extract from the example above
11769 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11770 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11771 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11772 4 frontend_name http-in
11773 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11774 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11775 7 status_code 200
11776 8 bytes_read* 2750
11777 9 captured_request_cookie -
11778 10 captured_response_cookie -
11779 11 termination_state ----
11780 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11781 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11782 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11783 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11784 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011785
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011786
11787Detailed fields description :
11788 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011789 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11790 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11791 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11792 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11793 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011794
11795 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011796 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11797 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11798 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011799
11800 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11801 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11802 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11803 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11804 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11805
11806 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11807 and processed the connection.
11808
11809 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11810 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11811 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11812
11813 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11814 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11815 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11816 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11817 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11818 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11819
11820 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11821 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11822 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11823 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11824 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11825 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11826
11827 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11828 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11829 See "Timers" below for more details.
11830
11831 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11832 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11833 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11834 below for more details.
11835
11836 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11837 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11838 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11839 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11840 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11841 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11842 for more details.
11843
11844 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011845 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011846 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11847 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11848 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11849 details.
11850
11851 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11852 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11853 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11854
11855 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11856 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11857 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11858 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11859 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11860 overflowing.
11861
11862 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11863 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11864 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11865 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11866 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11867 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11868 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11869 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11870
11871 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11872 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11873 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11874 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11875 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11876 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11877 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11878 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11879
11880 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11881 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11882 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11883 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11884 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11885 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11886 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11887
11888 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011889 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011890 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11891 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11892 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011893 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011894 system.
11895
11896 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11897 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11898 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11899 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11900 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11901 caused by a denial of service attack.
11902
11903 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11904 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11905 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11906 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11907 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11908 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11909 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11910 denial of service attack.
11911
11912 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11913 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11914 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11915 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11916 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11917 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11918 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11919 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11920 processed than on other servers.
11921
11922 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11923 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11924 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11925 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11926 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11927 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11928 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11929 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11930 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11931 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11932 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11933 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11934 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11935
11936 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11937 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11938 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11939 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11940 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11941 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11942 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11943 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11944
11945 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11946 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11947 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11948 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11949 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11950 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11951 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11952 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11953 occurs.
11954
11955 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11956 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11957 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11958 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11959 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11960 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11961 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11962 cookies" below for more details.
11963
11964 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11965 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11966 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11967 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11968 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11969 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11970 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11971 and cookies" below for more details.
11972
11973 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11974 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11975 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11976 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11977 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11978 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11979 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11980 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11981
11982
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200119838.2.4. Custom log format
11984------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011985
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011986The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011987mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011988
11989HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11990Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11991separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11992prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11993
11994Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11995variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11996string formats ("Q").
11997
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011998If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011999as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012000less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12001the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12002
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012003Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012004In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012005in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012006
12007Flags are :
12008 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012009 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012010
12011 Example:
12012
12013 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12014 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12015
12016At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12017
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012018 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12019 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012020
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012021the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012022
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012023 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012024 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012025 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012026
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012027and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12028
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012029 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012030 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12031
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012032Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12033
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012034 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012035 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012036 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12037 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12038 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012039 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12040 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12041 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012042 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012043 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012044 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012045 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012046 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012047 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012048 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12049 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012050 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012051 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12052 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012053 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012054 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12055 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012056 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12057 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12058 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012059 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012060 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12061 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012062 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012063 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12064 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12065 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012066 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012067 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12068 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12069 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12070 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012071 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012072 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012073 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012074 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012075 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012076 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012077 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12078 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12079 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012080 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012081 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12082 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012083 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012084 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012085 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012086 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012087
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012088 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012089
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012090
120918.2.5. Error log format
12092-----------------------
12093
12094When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12095protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12096By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12097"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12098will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12099logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12100
12101The format looks like this :
12102
12103 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12104 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12105 Connection error during SSL handshake
12106
12107 Field Format Extract from the example above
12108 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12109 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12110 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12111 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12112 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12113
12114These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12115failures.
12116
12117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121188.3. Advanced logging options
12119-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012120
12121Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12122just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12123options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12124for more information about their usage.
12125
12126
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121278.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12128------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012129
12130It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12131haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12132commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12133monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12134ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12135
12136 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12137 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12138 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12139 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12140
12141 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12142 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12143 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012144 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012145 such as other load-balancers.
12146
12147 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12148 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12149 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12150
12151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121528.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12153----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012154
12155The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12156what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12157or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12158"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12159just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12160log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12161after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12162is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12163with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12164with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12165
12166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121678.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12168------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012169
12170Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12171for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12172"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12173retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12174raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12175a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12176file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12177you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12178"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12179
12180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121818.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12182--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012183
12184Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12185multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12186them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12187"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12188logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12189error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12190and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12191too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12192useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12193alternative.
12194
12195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121968.4. Timing events
12197------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012198
12199Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12200reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12201the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12202frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12203mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12204
12205 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12206 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12207 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12208 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12209 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12210
12211 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12212 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12213 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12214 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12215 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12216
12217 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12218 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12219 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12220 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12221 connection never established.
12222
12223 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12224 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12225 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12226 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12227 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12228 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12229 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12230 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12231 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12232 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12233 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12234
12235 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12236 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12237 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12238 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012239 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012240
12241 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12242
12243 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12244 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12245 negative.
12246
12247These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12248protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12249that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012250due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012251close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12252session has been aborted on timeout.
12253
12254Most common cases :
12255
12256 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12257 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12258 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12259 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12260 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12261 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12262 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12263 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12264 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012265 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12266 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12267 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012268
12269 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12270 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12271 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12272 of ms on remote networks.
12273
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012274 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12275 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12276 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012277
12278 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12279 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12280 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12281 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12282 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12283 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12284 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12285 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12286 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12287 to the server until another one is released.
12288
12289Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12290
12291 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12292 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12293 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12294
12295 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12296 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12297 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12298
12299 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12300 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12301 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12302 flags.
12303
12304 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12305 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12306 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12307 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12308 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12309 the client connection was maintained open.
12310
12311 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012312 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012313 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12314 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12315
12316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123178.5. Session state at disconnection
12318-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012319
12320TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12321"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
123222-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12323each of which has a special meaning :
12324
12325 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12326 session to terminate :
12327
12328 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12329
12330 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12331 server explicitly refused it.
12332
12333 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12334 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12335 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12336 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012337 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12338
12339 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12340 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012341
12342 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12343 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12344 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12345 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12346 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12347
12348 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12349 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12350 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12351 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12352 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12353
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012354 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12355 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12356
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012357 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12358 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12359 backup connections when going up.
12360
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012361 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12362
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012363 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12364 send or receive data.
12365
12366 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12367 send or receive data.
12368
12369 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12370 with nothing left in the buffers.
12371
12372 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12373
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012374 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012375 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12376
12377 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12378 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12379 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12380 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12381 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12382
12383 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12384 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12385
12386 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12387 server (HTTP only).
12388
12389 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12390
12391 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12392 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12393 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12394
12395 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12396 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12397 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12398
12399 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12400
12401 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12402 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12403
12404 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12405 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12406 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12407
12408 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12409 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012410 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12411 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012412
12413 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12414 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12415 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12416 another server.
12417
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012418 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012419 server.
12420
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012421 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12422 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12423 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12424 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12425
12426 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12427 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12428 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12429 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12430
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012431 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12432 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12433 "use-server" rule).
12434
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012435 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12436
12437 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12438 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12439
12440 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12441
12442 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12443 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12444 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12445
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012446 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12447 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012448 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012449 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12450 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12451
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012452 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12453
12454 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12455 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12456
12457 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12458
12459 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12460
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012461The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12462was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012463helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12464starvation, attacks, etc...
12465
12466The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12467alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12468easier finding and understanding.
12469
12470 Flags Reason
12471
12472 -- Normal termination.
12473
12474 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12475 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12476 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12477 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12478
12479 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12480 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12481 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12482 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12483 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12484 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012485
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012486 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12487 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012488 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012489
12490 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12491 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12492 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12493
12494 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12495 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12496 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12497 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12498 the server takes too long to respond.
12499
12500 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12501 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12502 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12503 long a time to respond.
12504
12505 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12506 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12507 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12508 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12509 and the client.
12510
12511 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12512 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12513 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12514 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12515 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
12516 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
12517
12518 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12519 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012520 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12521 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12522 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12523 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012524
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012525 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12526 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12527
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012528 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012529 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12530 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12531 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12532 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12533 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12534
12535 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12536 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12537 503 or 504 here.
12538
12539 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12540 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12541 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12542 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12543 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12544
12545 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12546 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012547 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012548 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12549 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12550
12551 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12552 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12553 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12554 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12555 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12556 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12557 between haproxy and the server.
12558
12559 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12560 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12561 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12562 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12563 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12564 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12565 solution is to fix the application.
12566
12567 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12568 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12569 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12570 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12571 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12572 external attacks.
12573
12574 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12575 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012576 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012577 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12578 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12579
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012580 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12581 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12582 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012583 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12584 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012585
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012586 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12587 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12588 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12589 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012590 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12591 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12592 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12593 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12594 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012595
12596 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12597 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12598 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12599 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12600
12601 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12602 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12603 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12604 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12605
12606 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12607 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12608 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12609 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12610
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012611The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12612persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12613important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12614re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12615
12616 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12617
12618 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12619 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12620 set on a GET request.
12621
12622 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12623 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012624 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012625 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12626
12627 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12628 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12629 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12630
12631 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12632 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12633 already got a cookie.
12634
12635 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12636 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12637 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12638 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12639 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12640
12641 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12642 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12643 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12644
12645 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12646 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12647 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12648
12649 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12650 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12651
12652 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12653 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12654 then advertised in the response.
12655
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012656
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126578.6. Non-printable characters
12658-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012659
12660In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12661consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12662converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12663prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12664being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12665escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12666is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12667'}' when logging headers.
12668
12669Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12670issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12671containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12672
12673Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12674the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12675performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12676
12677
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126788.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12679---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012680
12681Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12682achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012683section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012684cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12685the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12686the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012687locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012688not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12689user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12690a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12691wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12692
12693 Examples :
12694 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12695 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12696
12697 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12698 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12699
12700
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127018.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12702---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012703
12704Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12705proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12706the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12707server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12708
12709Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12710response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012711section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012712
12713It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012714time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12715appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012716are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12717and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12718follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12719request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12720in the logs.
12721
12722 Example :
12723 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12724 listen proxy-out
12725 mode http
12726 option httplog
12727 option logasap
12728 log global
12729 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12730
12731 # log the name of the virtual server
12732 capture request header Host len 20
12733
12734 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12735 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12736
12737 # log the beginning of the referrer
12738 capture request header Referer len 20
12739
12740 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12741 capture response header Server len 20
12742
12743 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12744 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12745
12746 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12747 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12748
12749 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12750 capture response header Via len 20
12751
12752 # log the URL location during a redirection
12753 capture response header Location len 20
12754
12755 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12756 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12757 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12758 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12759 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12760
12761 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12762 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12763 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12764 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012765 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012766
12767 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12768 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12769 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12770 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12771 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012772 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012773
12774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127758.9. Examples of logs
12776---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012777
12778These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12779them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12780reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12781
12782 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12783 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12784 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12785
12786 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12787 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12788
12789 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12790 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12791 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12792
12793 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12794 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12795
12796 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12797 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12798 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12799
12800 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012801 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012802 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12803 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12804
12805 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12806 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12807 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12808
12809 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12810 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012811 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012812 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12813 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12814 to return the 502 and not the server.
12815
12816 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012817 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012818
12819 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12820 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12821 Nothing was sent to any server.
12822
12823 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12824 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12825
12826 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12827 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12828 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12829 send a 408 return code to the client.
12830
12831 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12832 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12833
12834 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12835 5 seconds ("c----").
12836
12837 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12838 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012839 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012840
12841 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012842 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012843 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12844 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12845 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12846 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12847 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012848
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012849
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128509. Statistics and monitoring
12851----------------------------
12852
12853It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12854mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12855CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12856Unix socket.
12857
12858
128599.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012860---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012861
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012862The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12863page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12864
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012865 0. pxname: proxy name
12866 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12867 for server)
12868 2. qcur: current queued requests
12869 3. qmax: max queued requests
12870 4. scur: current sessions
12871 5. smax: max sessions
12872 6. slim: sessions limit
12873 7. stot: total sessions
12874 8. bin: bytes in
12875 9. bout: bytes out
12876 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012877 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012878 12. ereq: request errors
12879 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012880 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012881 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12882 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012883 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012884 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12885 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12886 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12887 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12888 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12889 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12890 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12891 25. qlimit: queue limit
12892 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12893 27. iid: unique proxy id
12894 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12895 29. throttle: warm up status
12896 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12897 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012898 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012899 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12900 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12901 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012902 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012903 UNK -> unknown
12904 INI -> initializing
12905 SOCKERR -> socket error
12906 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12907 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12908 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12909 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12910 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12911 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12912 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12913 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12914 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12915 disable-on-404
12916 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12917 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12918 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012919 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12920 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012921 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12922 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12923 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12924 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12925 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12926 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012927 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12928 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12929 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12930 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012931 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12932 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012933 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12934 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12935 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012936 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010012937 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012938
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012939
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129409.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012941-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012942
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012943The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12944necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12945A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12946issuing commands by hand :
12947
12948 global
12949 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12950 stats timeout 2m
12951
12952It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12953the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12954never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12955situations :
12956
12957 global
12958 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12959 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12960 stats timeout 2m
12961
12962To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12963swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12964to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12965syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12966
12967 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12968 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12969
12970The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12971script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12972for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12973
12974The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12975that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12976editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12977(eg: watch a counter).
12978
12979The socket supports two operation modes :
12980 - interactive
12981 - non-interactive
12982
12983The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12984this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12985sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12986mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12987commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12988example :
12989
12990 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12991
12992The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12993entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12994for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12995sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12996"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12997after processing the last command of the same line.
12998
12999For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13000"prompt" command :
13001
13002 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13003 prompt
13004 > show info
13005 ...
13006 >
13007
13008Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13009delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13010that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13011parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013012
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013013It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13014on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13015own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013016
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013017The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13018If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13019all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13020it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13021
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013022add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013023 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13024 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13025 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13026 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013027
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013028add map <map> <key> <value>
13029 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13030 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013031 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13032 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13033 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013034
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013035clear counters
13036 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13037 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13038 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13039 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13040 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13041
13042clear counters all
13043 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13044 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13045 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13046
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013047clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013048 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13049 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13050 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013051
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013052clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013053 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13054 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13055 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013056
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013057clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13058 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13059
13060 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13061 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13062 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13063 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13064 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13065 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13066
13067 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13068
13069 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13070 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13071 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13072 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13073 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13074 the ACLs :
13075
13076 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13077 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13078 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13079 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13080 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13081 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13082
13083 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013084 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13085 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013086
13087 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013088 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013089 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013090 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13091 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13092 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13093 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013094
13095 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13096
13097 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013098 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013099 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13100 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013101 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13102 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13103 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013104
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013105del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13106 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013107 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13108 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13109 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13110 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013111
13112del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013113 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013114 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13115 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13116 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13117 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013118
13119disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013120 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13121
13122 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13123 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13124 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13125 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13126 re-enabled using enable agent.
13127
13128 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13129 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13130 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13131 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13132 otherwise unchanged.
13133
13134 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13135 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13136 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13137
13138 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13139 level "admin".
13140
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013141disable frontend <frontend>
13142 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13143 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13144 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13145 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13146 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13147 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13148 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13149 on the stats page.
13150
13151 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13152 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13153
13154 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13155 level "admin".
13156
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013157disable health <backend>/<server>
13158 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13159 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13160 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13161 agent check forces it down.
13162
13163 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13164 level "admin".
13165
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013166disable server <backend>/<server>
13167 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13168 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13169 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13170 during the maintenance.
13171
13172 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13173 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13174
13175 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013176 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013177
13178 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13179 level "admin".
13180
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013181enable agent <backend>/<server>
13182 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13183
13184 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13185 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13186
13187 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13188 level "admin".
13189
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013190enable frontend <frontend>
13191 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13192 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13193 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13194 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13195 which was disabled.
13196
13197 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13198 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13199
13200 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13201 level "admin".
13202
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013203enable health <backend>/<server>
13204 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13205 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13206
13207 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13208 level "admin".
13209
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013210enable server <backend>/<server>
13211 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13212 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13213
13214 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013215 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013216
13217 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13218 level "admin".
13219
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013220get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013221get acl <acl> <value>
13222 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13223 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13224 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13225 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13226 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013227
13228 The first two words are:
13229
13230 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13231 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13232 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13233
13234 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13235
13236 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13237
13238 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13239
13240 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13241 interpretation of the case.
13242
13243 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13244 useful with regular expressions.
13245
13246 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13247 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13248
13249 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13250 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13251 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13252
13253 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13254
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013255get weight <backend>/<server>
13256 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13257 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13258 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13259 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13260 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013261 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013262
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013263help
13264 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13265 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013266
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013267prompt
13268 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13269 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13270 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13271 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13272 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13273 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13274 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13275 command.
13276
13277quit
13278 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013279
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013280set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013281 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13282 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13283 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013284
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013285set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013286 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13287 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13288 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13289 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13290 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013291 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13292 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13293
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013294set maxconn global <maxconn>
13295 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13296 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13297 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13298 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13299 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13300 setting.
13301
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013302set rate-limit connections global <value>
13303 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13304 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13305 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13306 is passed in number of connections per second.
13307
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013308set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13309 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13310 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013311 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13312 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013313
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013314set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13315 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13316 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13317 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13318 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13319
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013320set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13321 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13322 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13323 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13324 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13325 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13326
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013327set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13328 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13329 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13330 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13331
13332set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13333 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13334 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13335 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13336
13337set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13338 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13339 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13340 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13341 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13342 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13343 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13344 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13345 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13346
13347set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13348 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13349 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13350
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013351set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013352 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13353 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13354 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13355 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013356 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13357 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013358
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013359set timeout cli <delay>
13360 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13361 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13362 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13363
13364set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13365 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13366 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013367 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13368 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13369 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13370 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13371 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13372 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13373 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13374 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13375 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13376 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13377 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13378 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13379 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013380
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013381show errors [<iid>]
13382 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13383 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013384 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13385 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13386 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013387
13388 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13389 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13390 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13391 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13392 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13393 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13394 are reported too.
13395
13396 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13397 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13398 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13399 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13400 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13401 code.
13402
13403 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13404 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13405 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13406 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13407 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13408 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13409 line.
13410
13411 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013412 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13413 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013414 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13415 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13416
13417 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13418 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13419 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13420 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13421 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13422 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13423 00204+ minal\r\n
13424 00211 \r\n
13425
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013426 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013427 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13428 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13429 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13430 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13431 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13432 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013433
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013434show info
13435 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13436
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013437show map [<map>]
13438 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013439 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13440 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13441 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13442 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13443 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13444 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013445
13446show acl [<acl>]
13447 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013448 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13449 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13450 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13451 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13452 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013453
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013454show pools
13455 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13456 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13457 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13458 the pools.
13459
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013460show sess
13461 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013462 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13463 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13464
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013465show sess <id>
13466 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13467 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13468 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13469 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13470 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013471 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13472 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13473 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013474
13475show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13476 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13477 possible to dump only selected items :
13478 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13479 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13480 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13481 for example:
13482 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13483 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13484 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13485
13486 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013487 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13488 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013489 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13490 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13491 Nbproc: 1
13492 Process_num: 1
13493 (...)
13494
13495 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13496 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13497 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13498 (...)
13499 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13500
13501 $
13502
13503 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13504 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13505 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13506 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013507 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013508
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013509show table
13510 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13511 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13512 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13513 entries currently in use.
13514
13515 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013516 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013517 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13518 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013519
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013520show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013521 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13522 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13523 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013524 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13525
13526 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13527 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13528 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13529 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13530 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13531
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013532 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13533 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13534 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13535 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13536 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13537 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13538
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013539
13540 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013541 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13542 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013543
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013544 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013545 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013546 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013547 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13548 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13549 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13550 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013551
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013552 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013553 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013554 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13555 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013556
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013557 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13558 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013559 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013560 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13561 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013562
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013563 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13564 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013565 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013566 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13567 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13568
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013569 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13570 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13571 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13572 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13573 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13574
13575 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13576 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13577 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013578 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13579 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013580 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13581 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013582
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013583shutdown frontend <frontend>
13584 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13585 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13586 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13587 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13588 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13589 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13590 once it is terminated.
13591
13592 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13593 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13594
13595 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13596 level "admin".
13597
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013598shutdown session <id>
13599 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13600 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13601 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13602 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13603 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13604 flag in the logs.
13605
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013606shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13607 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13608 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13609 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13610 'K' flag in the logs.
13611
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013612/*
13613 * Local variables:
13614 * fill-column: 79
13615 * End:
13616 */